1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Expands front end tree to back end RTL for GNU C-Compiler
|
2001-02-17 08:35:00 +00:00
|
|
|
|
Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1989, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
This file is part of GCC.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
|
|
|
|
|
the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
|
|
|
|
|
Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
|
|
|
|
|
version.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
|
|
|
|
|
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
|
|
|
|
|
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
|
|
|
|
|
for more details.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
|
|
|
|
|
Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
|
|
|
|
|
02111-1307, USA. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* $FreeBSD$ */
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* This file handles the generation of rtl code from tree structure
|
|
|
|
|
at the level of the function as a whole.
|
|
|
|
|
It creates the rtl expressions for parameters and auto variables
|
|
|
|
|
and has full responsibility for allocating stack slots.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
`expand_function_start' is called at the beginning of a function,
|
|
|
|
|
before the function body is parsed, and `expand_function_end' is
|
|
|
|
|
called after parsing the body.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Call `assign_stack_local' to allocate a stack slot for a local variable.
|
|
|
|
|
This is usually done during the RTL generation for the function body,
|
|
|
|
|
but it can also be done in the reload pass when a pseudo-register does
|
|
|
|
|
not get a hard register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Call `put_var_into_stack' when you learn, belatedly, that a variable
|
|
|
|
|
previously given a pseudo-register must in fact go in the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
This function changes the DECL_RTL to be a stack slot instead of a reg
|
|
|
|
|
then scans all the RTL instructions so far generated to correct them. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "config.h"
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "system.h"
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "rtl.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "tree.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "flags.h"
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "except.h"
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "function.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "expr.h"
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "libfuncs.h"
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "regs.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "hard-reg-set.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "insn-config.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "recog.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "output.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "basic-block.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "obstack.h"
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "toplev.h"
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "hash.h"
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#include "ggc.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "tm_p.h"
|
|
|
|
|
#include "integrate.h"
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
|
#define TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifndef LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
|
#define LOCAL_ALIGNMENT(TYPE, ALIGNMENT) ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Some systems use __main in a way incompatible with its use in gcc, in these
|
|
|
|
|
cases use the macros NAME__MAIN to give a quoted symbol and SYMBOL__MAIN to
|
|
|
|
|
give the same symbol without quotes for an alternative entry point. You
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
must define both, or neither. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifndef NAME__MAIN
|
|
|
|
|
#define NAME__MAIN "__main"
|
|
|
|
|
#define SYMBOL__MAIN __main
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Round a value to the lowest integer less than it that is a multiple of
|
|
|
|
|
the required alignment. Avoid using division in case the value is
|
|
|
|
|
negative. Assume the alignment is a power of two. */
|
|
|
|
|
#define FLOOR_ROUND(VALUE,ALIGN) ((VALUE) & ~((ALIGN) - 1))
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Similar, but round to the next highest integer that meets the
|
|
|
|
|
alignment. */
|
|
|
|
|
#define CEIL_ROUND(VALUE,ALIGN) (((VALUE) + (ALIGN) - 1) & ~((ALIGN)- 1))
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* NEED_SEPARATE_AP means that we cannot derive ap from the value of fp
|
|
|
|
|
during rtl generation. If they are different register numbers, this is
|
|
|
|
|
always true. It may also be true if
|
|
|
|
|
FIRST_PARM_OFFSET - STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET is not a constant during rtl
|
|
|
|
|
generation. See fix_lexical_addr for details. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
#define NEED_SEPARATE_AP
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if function being compiled doesn't contain any calls
|
|
|
|
|
(ignoring the prologue and epilogue). This is set prior to
|
|
|
|
|
local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
compiler passes. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int current_function_is_leaf;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if function being compiled doesn't contain any instructions
|
|
|
|
|
that can throw an exception. This is set prior to final. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int current_function_nothrow;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if function being compiled doesn't modify the stack pointer
|
|
|
|
|
(ignoring the prologue and epilogue). This is only valid after
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
life_analysis has run. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int current_function_sp_is_unchanging;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if the function being compiled is a leaf function which only
|
|
|
|
|
uses leaf registers. This is valid after reload (specifically after
|
|
|
|
|
sched2) and is useful only if the port defines LEAF_REGISTERS. */
|
|
|
|
|
int current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero once virtual register instantiation has been done.
|
|
|
|
|
assign_stack_local uses frame_pointer_rtx when this is nonzero.
|
|
|
|
|
calls.c:emit_library_call_value_1 uses it to set up
|
|
|
|
|
post-instantiation libcalls. */
|
|
|
|
|
int virtuals_instantiated;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* These variables hold pointers to functions to create and destroy
|
|
|
|
|
target specific, per-function data structures. */
|
|
|
|
|
void (*init_machine_status) PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
void (*free_machine_status) PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
/* This variable holds a pointer to a function to register any
|
|
|
|
|
data items in the target specific, per-function data structure
|
|
|
|
|
that will need garbage collection. */
|
|
|
|
|
void (*mark_machine_status) PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Likewise, but for language-specific data. */
|
|
|
|
|
void (*init_lang_status) PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
void (*save_lang_status) PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
void (*restore_lang_status) PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
void (*mark_lang_status) PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
void (*free_lang_status) PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The FUNCTION_DECL for an inline function currently being expanded. */
|
|
|
|
|
tree inline_function_decl;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The currently compiled function. */
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *cfun = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* These arrays record the INSN_UIDs of the prologue and epilogue insns. */
|
|
|
|
|
static varray_type prologue;
|
|
|
|
|
static varray_type epilogue;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Array of INSN_UIDs to hold the INSN_UIDs for each sibcall epilogue
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
in this function. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static varray_type sibcall_epilogue;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* In order to evaluate some expressions, such as function calls returning
|
|
|
|
|
structures in memory, we need to temporarily allocate stack locations.
|
|
|
|
|
We record each allocated temporary in the following structure.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Associated with each temporary slot is a nesting level. When we pop up
|
|
|
|
|
one level, all temporaries associated with the previous level are freed.
|
|
|
|
|
Normally, all temporaries are freed after the execution of the statement
|
|
|
|
|
in which they were created. However, if we are inside a ({...}) grouping,
|
|
|
|
|
the result may be in a temporary and hence must be preserved. If the
|
|
|
|
|
result could be in a temporary, we preserve it if we can determine which
|
|
|
|
|
one it is in. If we cannot determine which temporary may contain the
|
|
|
|
|
result, all temporaries are preserved. A temporary is preserved by
|
|
|
|
|
pretending it was allocated at the previous nesting level.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Automatic variables are also assigned temporary slots, at the nesting
|
|
|
|
|
level where they are defined. They are marked a "kept" so that
|
|
|
|
|
free_temp_slots will not free them. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Points to next temporary slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *next;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The rtx to used to reference the slot. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx slot;
|
|
|
|
|
/* The rtx used to represent the address if not the address of the
|
|
|
|
|
slot above. May be an EXPR_LIST if multiple addresses exist. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx address;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The alignment (in bits) of the slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
unsigned int align;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The size, in units, of the slot. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The type of the object in the slot, or zero if it doesn't correspond
|
|
|
|
|
to a type. We use this to determine whether a slot can be reused.
|
|
|
|
|
It can be reused if objects of the type of the new slot will always
|
|
|
|
|
conflict with objects of the type of the old slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
tree type;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The value of `sequence_rtl_expr' when this temporary is allocated. */
|
|
|
|
|
tree rtl_expr;
|
|
|
|
|
/* Non-zero if this temporary is currently in use. */
|
|
|
|
|
char in_use;
|
|
|
|
|
/* Non-zero if this temporary has its address taken. */
|
|
|
|
|
char addr_taken;
|
|
|
|
|
/* Nesting level at which this slot is being used. */
|
|
|
|
|
int level;
|
|
|
|
|
/* Non-zero if this should survive a call to free_temp_slots. */
|
|
|
|
|
int keep;
|
|
|
|
|
/* The offset of the slot from the frame_pointer, including extra space
|
|
|
|
|
for alignment. This info is for combine_temp_slots. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The size of the slot, including extra space for alignment. This
|
|
|
|
|
info is for combine_temp_slots. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT full_size;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
};
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* This structure is used to record MEMs or pseudos used to replace VAR, any
|
|
|
|
|
SUBREGs of VAR, and any MEMs containing VAR as an address. We need to
|
|
|
|
|
maintain this list in case two operands of an insn were required to match;
|
|
|
|
|
in that case we must ensure we use the same replacement. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx old;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx new;
|
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement *next;
|
|
|
|
|
};
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
struct insns_for_mem_entry
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The KEY in HE will be a MEM. */
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_entry he;
|
|
|
|
|
/* These are the INSNS which reference the MEM. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insns;
|
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Forward declarations. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static rtx assign_stack_local_1 PARAMS ((enum machine_mode, HOST_WIDE_INT,
|
|
|
|
|
int, struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
static struct temp_slot *find_temp_slot_from_address PARAMS ((rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
static void put_reg_into_stack PARAMS ((struct function *, rtx, tree,
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode, enum machine_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
int, unsigned int, int,
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void schedule_fixup_var_refs PARAMS ((struct function *, rtx, tree,
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void fixup_var_refs PARAMS ((rtx, enum machine_mode, int,
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static struct fixup_replacement
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
*find_fixup_replacement PARAMS ((struct fixup_replacement **, rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
static void fixup_var_refs_insns PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
int, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static void fixup_var_refs_insns_with_hash
|
|
|
|
|
PARAMS ((struct hash_table *, rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static void fixup_var_refs_insn PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
int, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static void fixup_var_refs_1 PARAMS ((rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx *, rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement **));
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx fixup_memory_subreg PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx walk_fixup_memory_subreg PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx fixup_stack_1 PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
static void optimize_bit_field PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, rtx *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void instantiate_decls PARAMS ((tree, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static void instantiate_decls_1 PARAMS ((tree, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static void instantiate_decl PARAMS ((rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx instantiate_new_reg PARAMS ((rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT *));
|
|
|
|
|
static int instantiate_virtual_regs_1 PARAMS ((rtx *, rtx, int));
|
|
|
|
|
static void delete_handlers PARAMS ((void));
|
|
|
|
|
static void pad_to_arg_alignment PARAMS ((struct args_size *, int,
|
|
|
|
|
struct args_size *));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifndef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static void pad_below PARAMS ((struct args_size *, enum machine_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
tree));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static rtx round_trampoline_addr PARAMS ((rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx adjust_trampoline_addr PARAMS ((rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
static tree *identify_blocks_1 PARAMS ((rtx, tree *, tree *, tree *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void reorder_blocks_0 PARAMS ((tree));
|
|
|
|
|
static void reorder_blocks_1 PARAMS ((rtx, tree, varray_type *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void reorder_fix_fragments PARAMS ((tree));
|
|
|
|
|
static tree blocks_nreverse PARAMS ((tree));
|
|
|
|
|
static int all_blocks PARAMS ((tree, tree *));
|
|
|
|
|
static tree *get_block_vector PARAMS ((tree, int *));
|
|
|
|
|
extern tree debug_find_var_in_block_tree PARAMS ((tree, tree));
|
|
|
|
|
/* We always define `record_insns' even if its not used so that we
|
|
|
|
|
can always export `prologue_epilogue_contains'. */
|
|
|
|
|
static void record_insns PARAMS ((rtx, varray_type *)) ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
|
|
|
|
static int contains PARAMS ((rtx, varray_type));
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_return
|
|
|
|
|
static void emit_return_into_block PARAMS ((basic_block, rtx));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static void put_addressof_into_stack PARAMS ((rtx, struct hash_table *));
|
|
|
|
|
static bool purge_addressof_1 PARAMS ((rtx *, rtx, int, int,
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void purge_single_hard_subreg_set PARAMS ((rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(HAVE_epilogue) && defined(INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX)
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx keep_stack_depressed PARAMS ((rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
static int is_addressof PARAMS ((rtx *, void *));
|
|
|
|
|
static struct hash_entry *insns_for_mem_newfunc PARAMS ((struct hash_entry *,
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *,
|
|
|
|
|
hash_table_key));
|
|
|
|
|
static unsigned long insns_for_mem_hash PARAMS ((hash_table_key));
|
|
|
|
|
static bool insns_for_mem_comp PARAMS ((hash_table_key, hash_table_key));
|
|
|
|
|
static int insns_for_mem_walk PARAMS ((rtx *, void *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void compute_insns_for_mem PARAMS ((rtx, rtx, struct hash_table *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void mark_function_status PARAMS ((struct function *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void maybe_mark_struct_function PARAMS ((void *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void prepare_function_start PARAMS ((void));
|
|
|
|
|
static void do_clobber_return_reg PARAMS ((rtx, void *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void do_use_return_reg PARAMS ((rtx, void *));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Pointer to chain of `struct function' for containing functions. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static struct function *outer_function_chain;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Given a function decl for a containing function,
|
|
|
|
|
return the `struct function' for it. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *
|
|
|
|
|
find_function_data (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *p;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (p = outer_function_chain; p; p = p->outer)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (p->decl == decl)
|
|
|
|
|
return p;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Save the current context for compilation of a nested function.
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
This is called from language-specific code. The caller should use
|
|
|
|
|
the save_lang_status callback to save any language-specific state,
|
|
|
|
|
since this function knows only about language-independent
|
|
|
|
|
variables. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
push_function_context_to (context)
|
|
|
|
|
tree context;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct function *p;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (context)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (context == current_function_decl)
|
|
|
|
|
cfun->contains_functions = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *containing = find_function_data (context);
|
|
|
|
|
containing->contains_functions = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (cfun == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
init_dummy_function_start ();
|
|
|
|
|
p = cfun;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p->outer = outer_function_chain;
|
|
|
|
|
outer_function_chain = p;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->fixup_var_refs_queue = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (save_lang_status)
|
|
|
|
|
(*save_lang_status) (p);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
cfun = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
push_function_context ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
push_function_context_to (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Restore the last saved context, at the end of a nested function.
|
|
|
|
|
This function is called from language-specific code. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
pop_function_context_from (context)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree context ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *p = outer_function_chain;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct var_refs_queue *queue;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
cfun = p;
|
|
|
|
|
outer_function_chain = p->outer;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_decl = p->decl;
|
|
|
|
|
reg_renumber = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
restore_emit_status (p);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (restore_lang_status)
|
|
|
|
|
(*restore_lang_status) (p);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Finish doing put_var_into_stack for any of our variables
|
|
|
|
|
which became addressable during the nested function. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (queue = p->fixup_var_refs_queue; queue; queue = queue->next)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs (queue->modified, queue->promoted_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
queue->unsignedp, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->fixup_var_refs_queue = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Reset variables that have known state during rtx generation. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx_equal_function_value_matters = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
virtuals_instantiated = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
generating_concat_p = 1;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
pop_function_context ()
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
pop_function_context_from (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Clear out all parts of the state in F that can safely be discarded
|
|
|
|
|
after the function has been parsed, but not compiled, to let
|
|
|
|
|
garbage collection reclaim the memory. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
free_after_parsing (f)
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *f;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* f->expr->forced_labels is used by code generation. */
|
|
|
|
|
/* f->emit->regno_reg_rtx is used by code generation. */
|
|
|
|
|
/* f->varasm is used by code generation. */
|
|
|
|
|
/* f->eh->eh_return_stub_label is used by code generation. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (free_lang_status)
|
|
|
|
|
(*free_lang_status) (f);
|
|
|
|
|
free_stmt_status (f);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Clear out all parts of the state in F that can safely be discarded
|
|
|
|
|
after the function has been compiled, to let garbage collection
|
|
|
|
|
reclaim the memory. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
free_after_compilation (f)
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *f;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
free_eh_status (f);
|
|
|
|
|
free_expr_status (f);
|
|
|
|
|
free_emit_status (f);
|
|
|
|
|
free_varasm_status (f);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (free_machine_status)
|
|
|
|
|
(*free_machine_status) (f);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (f->x_parm_reg_stack_loc)
|
|
|
|
|
free (f->x_parm_reg_stack_loc);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_temp_slots = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->arg_offset_rtx = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->return_rtx = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->internal_arg_pointer = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_nonlocal_labels = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_nonlocal_goto_handler_slots = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_nonlocal_goto_handler_labels = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_nonlocal_goto_stack_level = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_cleanup_label = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_return_label = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_save_expr_regs = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_stack_slot_list = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_rtl_expr_chain = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_tail_recursion_label = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_tail_recursion_reentry = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_arg_pointer_save_area = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_clobber_return_insn = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_context_display = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_trampoline_list = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_parm_birth_insn = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_last_parm_insn = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_parm_reg_stack_loc = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->fixup_var_refs_queue = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->original_arg_vector = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->original_decl_initial = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->inl_last_parm_insn = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
f->epilogue_delay_list = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate fixed slots in the stack frame of the current function. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Return size needed for stack frame based on slots so far allocated in
|
|
|
|
|
function F.
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
This size counts from zero. It is not rounded to PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
the caller may have to do that. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
get_func_frame_size (f)
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *f;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return -f->x_frame_offset;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return f->x_frame_offset;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Return size needed for stack frame based on slots so far allocated.
|
|
|
|
|
This size counts from zero. It is not rounded to PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY;
|
|
|
|
|
the caller may have to do that. */
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT
|
|
|
|
|
get_frame_size ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
return get_func_frame_size (cfun);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate a stack slot of SIZE bytes and return a MEM rtx for it
|
|
|
|
|
with machine mode MODE.
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
ALIGN controls the amount of alignment for the address of the slot:
|
|
|
|
|
0 means according to MODE,
|
|
|
|
|
-1 means use BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT and round size to multiple of that,
|
|
|
|
|
positive specifies alignment boundary in bits.
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
We do not round to stack_boundary here.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
FUNCTION specifies the function to allocate in. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx
|
|
|
|
|
assign_stack_local_1 (mode, size, align, function)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int align;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct function *function;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx x, addr;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int bigend_correction = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
int alignment;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int frame_off, frame_alignment, frame_phase;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (align == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree type;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (mode == BLKmode)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
alignment = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
alignment = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Allow the target to (possibly) increase the alignment of this
|
|
|
|
|
stack slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
type = type_for_mode (mode, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
if (type)
|
|
|
|
|
alignment = LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (type, alignment);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
alignment /= BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (align == -1)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
alignment = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
|
|
|
|
size = CEIL_ROUND (size, alignment);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
alignment = align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
function->x_frame_offset -= size;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Ignore alignment we can't do with expected alignment of the boundary. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT > PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY)
|
|
|
|
|
alignment = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (function->stack_alignment_needed < alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
|
|
|
|
function->stack_alignment_needed = alignment * BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate how many bytes the start of local variables is off from
|
|
|
|
|
stack alignment. */
|
|
|
|
|
frame_alignment = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
|
|
|
|
frame_off = STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET % frame_alignment;
|
|
|
|
|
frame_phase = frame_off ? frame_alignment - frame_off : 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Round frame offset to that alignment.
|
|
|
|
|
We must be careful here, since FRAME_OFFSET might be negative and
|
|
|
|
|
division with a negative dividend isn't as well defined as we might
|
|
|
|
|
like. So we instead assume that ALIGNMENT is a power of two and
|
|
|
|
|
use logical operations which are unambiguous. */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
function->x_frame_offset = FLOOR_ROUND (function->x_frame_offset - frame_phase, alignment) + frame_phase;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
function->x_frame_offset = CEIL_ROUND (function->x_frame_offset - frame_phase, alignment) + frame_phase;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* On a big-endian machine, if we are allocating more space than we will use,
|
|
|
|
|
use the least significant bytes of those that are allocated. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && mode != BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
bigend_correction = size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we have already instantiated virtual registers, return the actual
|
|
|
|
|
address relative to the frame pointer. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (function == cfun && virtuals_instantiated)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
addr = plus_constant (frame_pointer_rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
(frame_offset + bigend_correction
|
|
|
|
|
+ STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET));
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
addr = plus_constant (virtual_stack_vars_rtx,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
function->x_frame_offset + bigend_correction);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
function->x_frame_offset += size;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
x = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
function->x_stack_slot_list
|
|
|
|
|
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, function->x_stack_slot_list);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return x;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Wrapper around assign_stack_local_1; assign a local stack slot for the
|
|
|
|
|
current function. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
assign_stack_local (mode, size, align)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int align;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return assign_stack_local_1 (mode, size, align, cfun);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate a temporary stack slot and record it for possible later
|
|
|
|
|
reuse.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
MODE is the machine mode to be given to the returned rtx.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
SIZE is the size in units of the space required. We do no rounding here
|
|
|
|
|
since assign_stack_local will do any required rounding.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
KEEP is 1 if this slot is to be retained after a call to
|
|
|
|
|
free_temp_slots. Automatic variables for a block are allocated
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
with this flag. KEEP is 2 if we allocate a longer term temporary,
|
|
|
|
|
whose lifetime is controlled by CLEANUP_POINT_EXPRs. KEEP is 3
|
|
|
|
|
if we are to allocate something at an inner level to be treated as
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
a variable in the block (e.g., a SAVE_EXPR).
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
TYPE is the type that will be used for the stack slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, size, keep, type)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int keep;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree type;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unsigned int align;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p, *best_p = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If SIZE is -1 it means that somebody tried to allocate a temporary
|
|
|
|
|
of a variable size. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (size == -1)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (mode == BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
align = BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (! type)
|
|
|
|
|
type = type_for_mode (mode, 0);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (type)
|
|
|
|
|
align = LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (type, align);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Try to find an available, already-allocated temporary of the proper
|
|
|
|
|
mode which meets the size and alignment requirements. Choose the
|
|
|
|
|
smallest one with the closest alignment. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (p->align >= align && p->size >= size && GET_MODE (p->slot) == mode
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! p->in_use
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& objects_must_conflict_p (p->type, type)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& (best_p == 0 || best_p->size > p->size
|
|
|
|
|
|| (best_p->size == p->size && best_p->align > p->align)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->align == align && p->size == size)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
best_p = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
best_p = p;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make our best, if any, the one to use. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (best_p)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If there are enough aligned bytes left over, make them into a new
|
|
|
|
|
temp_slot so that the extra bytes don't get wasted. Do this only
|
|
|
|
|
for BLKmode slots, so that we can be sure of the alignment. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (best_p->slot) == BLKmode)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int alignment = best_p->align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT rounded_size = CEIL_ROUND (size, alignment);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (best_p->size - rounded_size >= alignment)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p = (struct temp_slot *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct temp_slot));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->in_use = p->addr_taken = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
p->size = best_p->size - rounded_size;
|
|
|
|
|
p->base_offset = best_p->base_offset + rounded_size;
|
|
|
|
|
p->full_size = best_p->full_size - rounded_size;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->slot = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode,
|
|
|
|
|
plus_constant (XEXP (best_p->slot, 0),
|
|
|
|
|
rounded_size));
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->align = best_p->align;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->address = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
p->rtl_expr = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->type = best_p->type;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->next = temp_slots;
|
|
|
|
|
temp_slots = p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
stack_slot_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, p->slot,
|
|
|
|
|
stack_slot_list);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
best_p->size = rounded_size;
|
|
|
|
|
best_p->full_size = rounded_size;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p = best_p;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we still didn't find one, make a new temporary. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (p == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT frame_offset_old = frame_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p = (struct temp_slot *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct temp_slot));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* We are passing an explicit alignment request to assign_stack_local.
|
|
|
|
|
One side effect of that is assign_stack_local will not round SIZE
|
|
|
|
|
to ensure the frame offset remains suitably aligned.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
So for requests which depended on the rounding of SIZE, we go ahead
|
|
|
|
|
and round it now. We also make sure ALIGNMENT is at least
|
|
|
|
|
BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
|
1999-11-01 18:56:02 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (mode == BLKmode && align < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->slot = assign_stack_local (mode,
|
1999-11-01 18:56:02 +00:00
|
|
|
|
(mode == BLKmode
|
|
|
|
|
? CEIL_ROUND (size, align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
|
|
|
|
: size),
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
align);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p->align = align;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The following slot size computation is necessary because we don't
|
|
|
|
|
know the actual size of the temporary slot until assign_stack_local
|
|
|
|
|
has performed all the frame alignment and size rounding for the
|
|
|
|
|
requested temporary. Note that extra space added for alignment
|
|
|
|
|
can be either above or below this stack slot depending on which
|
|
|
|
|
way the frame grows. We include the extra space if and only if it
|
|
|
|
|
is above this slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
|
p->size = frame_offset_old - frame_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
p->size = size;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Now define the fields used by combine_temp_slots. */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
|
p->base_offset = frame_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
p->full_size = frame_offset_old - frame_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
p->base_offset = frame_offset_old;
|
|
|
|
|
p->full_size = frame_offset - frame_offset_old;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
p->address = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
p->next = temp_slots;
|
|
|
|
|
temp_slots = p;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p->in_use = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
p->addr_taken = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->rtl_expr = seq_rtl_expr;
|
|
|
|
|
p->type = type;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (keep == 2)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
p->level = target_temp_slot_level;
|
|
|
|
|
p->keep = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (keep == 3)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
p->level = var_temp_slot_level;
|
|
|
|
|
p->keep = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
p->level = temp_slot_level;
|
|
|
|
|
p->keep = keep;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We may be reusing an old slot, so clear any MEM flags that may have been
|
|
|
|
|
set from before. */
|
|
|
|
|
RTX_UNCHANGING_P (p->slot) = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (p->slot) = 0;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
MEM_SCALAR_P (p->slot) = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
MEM_VOLATILE_P (p->slot) = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_alias_set (p->slot, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we know the alias set for the memory that will be used, use
|
|
|
|
|
it. If there's no TYPE, then we don't know anything about the
|
|
|
|
|
alias set for the memory. */
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_alias_set (p->slot, type ? get_alias_set (type) : 0);
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_align (p->slot, align);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If a type is specified, set the relevant flags. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (type != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
RTX_UNCHANGING_P (p->slot) = TYPE_READONLY (type);
|
|
|
|
|
MEM_VOLATILE_P (p->slot) = TYPE_VOLATILE (type);
|
|
|
|
|
MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (p->slot, AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return p->slot;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate a temporary stack slot and record it for possible later
|
|
|
|
|
reuse. First three arguments are same as in preceding function. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
assign_stack_temp (mode, size, keep)
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode;
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size;
|
|
|
|
|
int keep;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
return assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, size, keep, NULL_TREE);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Assign a temporary of given TYPE.
|
|
|
|
|
KEEP is as for assign_stack_temp.
|
|
|
|
|
MEMORY_REQUIRED is 1 if the result must be addressable stack memory;
|
|
|
|
|
it is 0 if a register is OK.
|
|
|
|
|
DONT_PROMOTE is 1 if we should not promote values in register
|
|
|
|
|
to wider modes. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
assign_temp (type, keep, memory_required, dont_promote)
|
|
|
|
|
tree type;
|
|
|
|
|
int keep;
|
|
|
|
|
int memory_required;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int dont_promote ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifndef PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (type);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (mode == BLKmode || memory_required)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tmp;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Zero sized arrays are GNU C extension. Set size to 1 to avoid
|
|
|
|
|
problems with allocating the stack space. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (size == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
size = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Unfortunately, we don't yet know how to allocate variable-sized
|
|
|
|
|
temporaries. However, sometimes we have a fixed upper limit on
|
|
|
|
|
the size (which is stored in TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE) and can use that
|
|
|
|
|
instead. This is the case for Chill variable-sized strings. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (size == -1 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
|
|
|
|
|
&& TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (type) != NULL_TREE
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& host_integerp (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (type), 1))
|
|
|
|
|
size = tree_low_cst (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (type), 1);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tmp = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, size, keep, type);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return tmp;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
|
|
|
|
|
if (! dont_promote)
|
|
|
|
|
mode = promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Combine temporary stack slots which are adjacent on the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This allows for better use of already allocated stack space. This is only
|
|
|
|
|
done for BLKmode slots because we can be sure that we won't have alignment
|
|
|
|
|
problems in this case. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
combine_temp_slots ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p, *q;
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *prev_p, *prev_q;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int num_slots;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* We can't combine slots, because the information about which slot
|
|
|
|
|
is in which alias set will be lost. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (flag_strict_aliasing)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If there are a lot of temp slots, don't do anything unless
|
|
|
|
|
high levels of optimization. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (! flag_expensive_optimizations)
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots, num_slots = 0; p; p = p->next, num_slots++)
|
|
|
|
|
if (num_slots > 100 || (num_slots > 10 && optimize == 0))
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots, prev_p = 0; p; p = prev_p ? prev_p->next : temp_slots)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int delete_p = 0;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (! p->in_use && GET_MODE (p->slot) == BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
for (q = p->next, prev_q = p; q; q = prev_q->next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int delete_q = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
if (! q->in_use && GET_MODE (q->slot) == BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->base_offset + p->full_size == q->base_offset)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Q comes after P; combine Q into P. */
|
|
|
|
|
p->size += q->size;
|
|
|
|
|
p->full_size += q->full_size;
|
|
|
|
|
delete_q = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (q->base_offset + q->full_size == p->base_offset)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* P comes after Q; combine P into Q. */
|
|
|
|
|
q->size += p->size;
|
|
|
|
|
q->full_size += p->full_size;
|
|
|
|
|
delete_p = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
/* Either delete Q or advance past it. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (delete_q)
|
|
|
|
|
prev_q->next = q->next;
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
prev_q = q;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
/* Either delete P or advance past it. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (delete_p)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (prev_p)
|
|
|
|
|
prev_p->next = p->next;
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
temp_slots = p->next;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
prev_p = p;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Find the temp slot corresponding to the object at address X. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static struct temp_slot *
|
|
|
|
|
find_temp_slot_from_address (x)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx next;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (! p->in_use)
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (XEXP (p->slot, 0) == x
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| p->address == x
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
|
|
|
|
|
&& XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
|
|
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= p->base_offset
|
|
|
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < p->base_offset + p->full_size))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
else if (p->address != 0 && GET_CODE (p->address) == EXPR_LIST)
|
|
|
|
|
for (next = p->address; next; next = XEXP (next, 1))
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (next, 0) == x)
|
|
|
|
|
return p;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a sum involving a register, see if it points to a temp
|
|
|
|
|
slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& (p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0))) != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return p;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& (p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 1))) != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate that NEW is an alternate way of referring to the temp slot
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
that previously was known by OLD. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
update_temp_slot_address (old, new)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx old, new;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (old, new))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p = find_temp_slot_from_address (old);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we didn't find one, see if both OLD is a PLUS. If so, and NEW
|
|
|
|
|
is a register, see if one operand of the PLUS is a temporary
|
|
|
|
|
location. If so, NEW points into it. Otherwise, if both OLD and
|
|
|
|
|
NEW are a PLUS and if there is a register in common between them.
|
|
|
|
|
If so, try a recursive call on those values. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (p == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (old) != PLUS)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (new) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), new);
|
|
|
|
|
update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), new);
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (new) != PLUS)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 1));
|
|
|
|
|
else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 1));
|
|
|
|
|
else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 1)))
|
|
|
|
|
update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (old, 1), XEXP (new, 1)))
|
|
|
|
|
update_temp_slot_address (XEXP (old, 0), XEXP (new, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise add an alias for the temp's address. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (p->address == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
p->address = new;
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (p->address) != EXPR_LIST)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->address = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, p->address, NULL_RTX);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->address = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, new, p->address);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If X could be a reference to a temporary slot, mark the fact that its
|
|
|
|
|
address was taken. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
mark_temp_addr_taken (x)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (x == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If X is not in memory or is at a constant address, it cannot be in
|
|
|
|
|
a temporary slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
if (p != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
p->addr_taken = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If X could be a reference to a temporary slot, mark that slot as
|
|
|
|
|
belonging to the to one level higher than the current level. If X
|
|
|
|
|
matched one of our slots, just mark that one. Otherwise, we can't
|
|
|
|
|
easily predict which it is, so upgrade all of them. Kept slots
|
|
|
|
|
need not be touched.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
This is called when an ({...}) construct occurs and a statement
|
|
|
|
|
returns a value in memory. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
preserve_temp_slots (x)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If there is no result, we still might have some objects whose address
|
|
|
|
|
were taken, so we need to make sure they stay around. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (x == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->in_use && p->level == temp_slot_level && p->addr_taken)
|
|
|
|
|
p->level--;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If X is a register that is being used as a pointer, see if we have
|
|
|
|
|
a temporary slot we know it points to. To be consistent with
|
|
|
|
|
the code below, we really should preserve all non-kept slots
|
|
|
|
|
if we can't find a match, but that seems to be much too costly. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG && REG_POINTER (x))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p = find_temp_slot_from_address (x);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If X is not in memory or is at a constant address, it cannot be in
|
|
|
|
|
a temporary slot, but it can contain something whose address was
|
|
|
|
|
taken. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (p == 0 && (GET_CODE (x) != MEM || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0))))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->in_use && p->level == temp_slot_level && p->addr_taken)
|
|
|
|
|
p->level--;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* First see if we can find a match. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (p == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (p != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Move everything at our level whose address was taken to our new
|
|
|
|
|
level in case we used its address. */
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *q;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (p->level == temp_slot_level)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
for (q = temp_slots; q; q = q->next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (q != p && q->addr_taken && q->level == p->level)
|
|
|
|
|
q->level--;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->level--;
|
|
|
|
|
p->addr_taken = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise, preserve all non-kept slots at this level. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->in_use && p->level == temp_slot_level && ! p->keep)
|
|
|
|
|
p->level--;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* X is the result of an RTL_EXPR. If it is a temporary slot associated
|
|
|
|
|
with that RTL_EXPR, promote it into a temporary slot at the present
|
|
|
|
|
level so it will not be freed when we free slots made in the
|
|
|
|
|
RTL_EXPR. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
preserve_rtl_expr_result (x)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If X is not in memory or is at a constant address, it cannot be in
|
|
|
|
|
a temporary slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (x == 0 || GET_CODE (x) != MEM || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we can find a match, move it to our level unless it is already at
|
|
|
|
|
an upper level. */
|
|
|
|
|
p = find_temp_slot_from_address (XEXP (x, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
if (p != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
p->level = MIN (p->level, temp_slot_level);
|
|
|
|
|
p->rtl_expr = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Free all temporaries used so far. This is normally called at the end
|
|
|
|
|
of generating code for a statement. Don't free any temporaries
|
|
|
|
|
currently in use for an RTL_EXPR that hasn't yet been emitted.
|
|
|
|
|
We could eventually do better than this since it can be reused while
|
|
|
|
|
generating the same RTL_EXPR, but this is complex and probably not
|
|
|
|
|
worthwhile. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
free_temp_slots ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->in_use && p->level == temp_slot_level && ! p->keep
|
|
|
|
|
&& p->rtl_expr == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
p->in_use = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
combine_temp_slots ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Free all temporary slots used in T, an RTL_EXPR node. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
free_temps_for_rtl_expr (t)
|
|
|
|
|
tree t;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->rtl_expr == t)
|
2001-01-03 17:17:01 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this slot is below the current TEMP_SLOT_LEVEL, then it
|
|
|
|
|
needs to be preserved. This can happen if a temporary in
|
|
|
|
|
the RTL_EXPR was addressed; preserve_temp_slots will move
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
the temporary into a higher level. */
|
2001-01-03 17:17:01 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (temp_slot_level <= p->level)
|
|
|
|
|
p->in_use = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
p->rtl_expr = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
combine_temp_slots ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Mark all temporaries ever allocated in this function as not suitable
|
|
|
|
|
for reuse until the current level is exited. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
mark_all_temps_used ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
p->in_use = p->keep = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
p->level = MIN (p->level, temp_slot_level);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Push deeper into the nesting level for stack temporaries. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
push_temp_slots ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
temp_slot_level++;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Likewise, but save the new level as the place to allocate variables
|
|
|
|
|
for blocks. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#if 0
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
push_temp_slots_for_block ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
push_temp_slots ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
var_temp_slot_level = temp_slot_level;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Likewise, but save the new level as the place to allocate temporaries
|
|
|
|
|
for TARGET_EXPRs. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
push_temp_slots_for_target ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
push_temp_slots ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
target_temp_slot_level = temp_slot_level;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Set and get the value of target_temp_slot_level. The only
|
|
|
|
|
permitted use of these functions is to save and restore this value. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
|
|
|
get_target_temp_slot_level ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
return target_temp_slot_level;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
set_target_temp_slot_level (level)
|
|
|
|
|
int level;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
target_temp_slot_level = level;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Pop a temporary nesting level. All slots in use in the current level
|
|
|
|
|
are freed. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
pop_temp_slots ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (p = temp_slots; p; p = p->next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->in_use && p->level == temp_slot_level && p->rtl_expr == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
p->in_use = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
combine_temp_slots ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
temp_slot_level--;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize temporary slots. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
init_temp_slots ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* We have not allocated any temporaries yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
temp_slots = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
temp_slot_level = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
var_temp_slot_level = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
target_temp_slot_level = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Retroactively move an auto variable from a register to a stack slot.
|
|
|
|
|
This is done when an address-reference to the variable is seen. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
put_var_into_stack (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx reg;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode, decl_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *function = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
tree context;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int can_use_addressof;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int volatilep = TREE_CODE (decl) != SAVE_EXPR && TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl);
|
|
|
|
|
int usedp = (TREE_USED (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
|| (TREE_CODE (decl) != SAVE_EXPR && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != 0));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
context = decl_function_context (decl);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Get the current rtl used for this object and its original mode. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
reg = (TREE_CODE (decl) == SAVE_EXPR
|
|
|
|
|
? SAVE_EXPR_RTL (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
: DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* No need to do anything if decl has no rtx yet
|
|
|
|
|
since in that case caller is setting TREE_ADDRESSABLE
|
|
|
|
|
and a stack slot will be assigned when the rtl is made. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (reg == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Get the declared mode for this object. */
|
|
|
|
|
decl_mode = (TREE_CODE (decl) == SAVE_EXPR ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
: DECL_MODE (decl));
|
|
|
|
|
/* Get the mode it's actually stored in. */
|
|
|
|
|
promoted_mode = GET_MODE (reg);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If this variable comes from an outer function, find that
|
|
|
|
|
function's saved context. Don't use find_function_data here,
|
|
|
|
|
because it might not be in any active function.
|
|
|
|
|
FIXME: Is that really supposed to happen?
|
|
|
|
|
It does in ObjC at least. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (context != current_function_decl && context != inline_function_decl)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (function = outer_function_chain; function; function = function->outer)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (function->decl == context)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a variable-size object with a pseudo to address it,
|
|
|
|
|
put that pseudo into the stack, if the var is nonlocal. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (decl) != SAVE_EXPR && DECL_NONLOCAL (decl)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (reg) == MEM
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (reg, 0)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& REGNO (XEXP (reg, 0)) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
reg = XEXP (reg, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
decl_mode = promoted_mode = GET_MODE (reg);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
can_use_addressof
|
|
|
|
|
= (function == 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& optimize > 0
|
|
|
|
|
/* FIXME make it work for promoted modes too */
|
|
|
|
|
&& decl_mode == promoted_mode
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef NON_SAVING_SETJMP
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! (NON_SAVING_SETJMP && current_function_calls_setjmp)
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we can't use ADDRESSOF, make sure we see through one we already
|
|
|
|
|
generated. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (! can_use_addressof && GET_CODE (reg) == MEM
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (reg, 0)) == ADDRESSOF)
|
|
|
|
|
reg = XEXP (XEXP (reg, 0), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Now we should have a value that resides in one or more pseudo regs. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg) == REG)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this variable lives in the current function and we don't need
|
|
|
|
|
to put things in the stack for the sake of setjmp, try to keep it
|
|
|
|
|
in a register until we know we actually need the address. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (can_use_addressof)
|
|
|
|
|
gen_mem_addressof (reg, decl);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
put_reg_into_stack (function, reg, TREE_TYPE (decl), promoted_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
decl_mode, volatilep, 0, usedp, 0);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (reg) == CONCAT)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* A CONCAT contains two pseudos; put them both in the stack.
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
We do it so they end up consecutive.
|
|
|
|
|
We fixup references to the parts only after we fixup references
|
|
|
|
|
to the whole CONCAT, lest we do double fixups for the latter
|
|
|
|
|
references. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode part_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (reg, 0));
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree part_type = type_for_mode (part_mode, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx lopart = XEXP (reg, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx hipart = XEXP (reg, 1);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
|
/* Since part 0 should have a lower address, do it second. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
put_reg_into_stack (function, hipart, part_type, part_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
part_mode, volatilep, 0, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
put_reg_into_stack (function, lopart, part_type, part_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
part_mode, volatilep, 0, 0, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
put_reg_into_stack (function, lopart, part_type, part_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
part_mode, volatilep, 0, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
put_reg_into_stack (function, hipart, part_type, part_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
part_mode, volatilep, 0, 0, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Change the CONCAT into a combined MEM for both parts. */
|
|
|
|
|
PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
MEM_ATTRS (reg) = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* set_mem_attributes uses DECL_RTL to avoid re-generating of
|
|
|
|
|
already computed alias sets. Here we want to re-generate. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_P (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (decl, NULL);
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (reg, decl, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_P (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (decl, reg);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* The two parts are in memory order already.
|
|
|
|
|
Use the lower parts address as ours. */
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (reg, 0) = XEXP (XEXP (reg, 0), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
/* Prevent sharing of rtl that might lose. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (reg, 0)) == PLUS)
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (reg, 0) = copy_rtx (XEXP (reg, 0));
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (usedp)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
schedule_fixup_var_refs (function, reg, TREE_TYPE (decl),
|
|
|
|
|
promoted_mode, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
schedule_fixup_var_refs (function, lopart, part_type, part_mode, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
schedule_fixup_var_refs (function, hipart, part_type, part_mode, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Subroutine of put_var_into_stack. This puts a single pseudo reg REG
|
|
|
|
|
into the stack frame of FUNCTION (0 means the current function).
|
|
|
|
|
DECL_MODE is the machine mode of the user-level data type.
|
|
|
|
|
PROMOTED_MODE is the machine mode of the register.
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
VOLATILE_P is nonzero if this is for a "volatile" decl.
|
|
|
|
|
USED_P is nonzero if this reg might have already been used in an insn. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
put_reg_into_stack (function, reg, type, promoted_mode, decl_mode, volatile_p,
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
original_regno, used_p, ht)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct function *function;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx reg;
|
|
|
|
|
tree type;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode, decl_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
int volatile_p;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unsigned int original_regno;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int used_p;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct function *func = function ? function : cfun;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx new = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unsigned int regno = original_regno;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (regno == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
regno = REGNO (reg);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (regno < func->x_max_parm_reg)
|
|
|
|
|
new = func->x_parm_reg_stack_loc[regno];
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (new == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
new = assign_stack_local_1 (decl_mode, GET_MODE_SIZE (decl_mode), 0, func);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
PUT_MODE (reg, decl_mode);
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (reg, 0) = XEXP (new, 0);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
MEM_ATTRS (reg) = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* `volatil' bit means one thing for MEMs, another entirely for REGs. */
|
|
|
|
|
MEM_VOLATILE_P (reg) = volatile_p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a memory ref that contains aggregate components,
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mark it as such for cse and loop optimize. If we are reusing a
|
|
|
|
|
previously generated stack slot, then we need to copy the bit in
|
|
|
|
|
case it was set for other reasons. For instance, it is set for
|
|
|
|
|
__builtin_va_alist. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (type)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (reg,
|
|
|
|
|
AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (new));
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_alias_set (reg, get_alias_set (type));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (used_p)
|
|
|
|
|
schedule_fixup_var_refs (function, reg, type, promoted_mode, ht);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure that all refs to the variable, previously made
|
|
|
|
|
when it was a register, are fixed up to be valid again.
|
|
|
|
|
See function above for meaning of arguments. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
schedule_fixup_var_refs (function, reg, type, promoted_mode, ht)
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *function;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx reg;
|
|
|
|
|
tree type;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int unsigned_p = type ? TREE_UNSIGNED (type) : 0;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (function != 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct var_refs_queue *temp;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
temp
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
= (struct var_refs_queue *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct var_refs_queue));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
temp->modified = reg;
|
|
|
|
|
temp->promoted_mode = promoted_mode;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
temp->unsignedp = unsigned_p;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
temp->next = function->fixup_var_refs_queue;
|
|
|
|
|
function->fixup_var_refs_queue = temp;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Variable is local; fix it up now. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs (reg, promoted_mode, unsigned_p, ht);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs (var, promoted_mode, unsignedp, ht)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx var;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
int unsignedp;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree pending;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx first_insn = get_insns ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct sequence_stack *stack = seq_stack;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree rtl_exps = rtl_expr_chain;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If there's a hash table, it must record all uses of VAR. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (ht)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (stack != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insns_with_hash (ht, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp);
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insns (first_insn, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp,
|
|
|
|
|
stack == 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan all pending sequences too. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (; stack; stack = stack->next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
push_to_full_sequence (stack->first, stack->last);
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insns (stack->first, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp,
|
|
|
|
|
stack->next != 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Update remembered end of sequence
|
|
|
|
|
in case we added an insn at the end. */
|
|
|
|
|
stack->last = get_last_insn ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan all waiting RTL_EXPRs too. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (pending = rtl_exps; pending; pending = TREE_CHAIN (pending))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq = RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (TREE_VALUE (pending));
|
|
|
|
|
if (seq != const0_rtx && seq != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
push_to_sequence (seq);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insns (seq, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* REPLACEMENTS is a pointer to a list of the struct fixup_replacement and X is
|
|
|
|
|
some part of an insn. Return a struct fixup_replacement whose OLD
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
value is equal to X. Allocate a new structure if no such entry exists. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static struct fixup_replacement *
|
|
|
|
|
find_fixup_replacement (replacements, x)
|
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement **replacements;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement *p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* See if we have already replaced this. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (p = *replacements; p != 0 && ! rtx_equal_p (p->old, x); p = p->next)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (p == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p = (struct fixup_replacement *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct fixup_replacement));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p->old = x;
|
|
|
|
|
p->new = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
p->next = *replacements;
|
|
|
|
|
*replacements = p;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return p;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan the insn-chain starting with INSN for refs to VAR
|
|
|
|
|
and fix them up. TOPLEVEL is nonzero if this chain is the
|
|
|
|
|
main chain of insns for the current function. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insns (insn, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp, toplevel)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx var;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
int unsignedp;
|
|
|
|
|
int toplevel;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
while (insn)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* fixup_var_refs_insn might modify insn, so save its next
|
|
|
|
|
pointer now. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* CALL_PLACEHOLDERs are special; we have to switch into each of
|
|
|
|
|
the three sequences they (potentially) contain, and process
|
|
|
|
|
them recursively. The CALL_INSN itself is not interesting. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CALL_PLACEHOLDER)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Look at the Normal call, sibling call and tail recursion
|
|
|
|
|
sequences attached to the CALL_PLACEHOLDER. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < 3; i++)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq = XEXP (PATTERN (insn), i);
|
|
|
|
|
if (seq)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
push_to_sequence (seq);
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insns (seq, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (PATTERN (insn), i) = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
else if (INSN_P (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insn (insn, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp, toplevel);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
insn = next;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Look up the insns which reference VAR in HT and fix them up. Other
|
|
|
|
|
arguments are the same as fixup_var_refs_insns.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
N.B. No need for special processing of CALL_PLACEHOLDERs here,
|
|
|
|
|
because the hash table will point straight to the interesting insn
|
|
|
|
|
(inside the CALL_PLACEHOLDER). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insns_with_hash (ht, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx var;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
int unsignedp;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct insns_for_mem_entry *ime = (struct insns_for_mem_entry *)
|
|
|
|
|
hash_lookup (ht, var, /*create=*/0, /*copy=*/0);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn_list = ime->insns;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
while (insn_list)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insn = XEXP (insn_list, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (INSN_P (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insn (insn, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insn_list = XEXP (insn_list, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Per-insn processing by fixup_var_refs_insns(_with_hash). INSN is
|
|
|
|
|
the insn under examination, VAR is the variable to fix up
|
|
|
|
|
references to, PROMOTED_MODE and UNSIGNEDP describe VAR, and
|
|
|
|
|
TOPLEVEL is nonzero if this is the main insn chain for this
|
|
|
|
|
function. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insn (insn, var, promoted_mode, unsignedp, toplevel)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx var;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
int unsignedp;
|
|
|
|
|
int toplevel;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx call_dest = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx set, prev, prev_set;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx note;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Remember the notes in case we delete the insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
note = REG_NOTES (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a CLOBBER of VAR, delete it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If it has a REG_LIBCALL note, delete the REG_LIBCALL
|
|
|
|
|
and REG_RETVAL notes too. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
|
|
|
|
|
&& (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0) == var
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) == CONCAT
|
|
|
|
|
&& (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 0) == var
|
|
|
|
|
|| XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0), 1) == var))))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if ((note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_LIBCALL, NULL_RTX)) != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
/* The REG_LIBCALL note will go away since we are going to
|
|
|
|
|
turn INSN into a NOTE, so just delete the
|
|
|
|
|
corresponding REG_RETVAL note. */
|
|
|
|
|
remove_note (XEXP (note, 0),
|
|
|
|
|
find_reg_note (XEXP (note, 0), REG_RETVAL,
|
|
|
|
|
NULL_RTX));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
delete_insn (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* The insn to load VAR from a home in the arglist
|
|
|
|
|
is now a no-op. When we see it, just delete it.
|
|
|
|
|
Similarly if this is storing VAR from a register from which
|
|
|
|
|
it was loaded in the previous insn. This will occur
|
|
|
|
|
when an ADDRESSOF was made for an arglist slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
else if (toplevel
|
|
|
|
|
&& (set = single_set (insn)) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& SET_DEST (set) == var
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this represents the result of an insn group,
|
|
|
|
|
don't delete the insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
&& find_reg_note (insn, REG_RETVAL, NULL_RTX) == 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& (rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (set), var)
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& (prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& (prev_set = single_set (prev)) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& SET_DEST (prev_set) == SET_SRC (set)
|
|
|
|
|
&& rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (prev_set), var))))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
delete_insn (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement *replacements = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx next_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If the insn that copies the results of a CALL_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
into a pseudo now references VAR, we have to use an
|
|
|
|
|
intermediate pseudo since we want the life of the
|
|
|
|
|
return value register to be only a single insn.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If we don't use an intermediate pseudo, such things as
|
|
|
|
|
address computations to make the address of VAR valid
|
|
|
|
|
if it is not can be placed between the CALL_INSN and INSN.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
To make sure this doesn't happen, we record the destination
|
|
|
|
|
of the CALL_INSN and see if the next insn uses both that
|
|
|
|
|
and VAR. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (call_dest != 0 && GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
|
|
|
|
|
&& reg_mentioned_p (var, PATTERN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
&& reg_mentioned_p (call_dest, PATTERN (insn)))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (call_dest));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_move_insn (temp, call_dest), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
PATTERN (insn) = replace_rtx (PATTERN (insn),
|
|
|
|
|
call_dest, temp);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
|
|
|
|
|
call_dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (insn));
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == SET)
|
|
|
|
|
call_dest = SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
call_dest = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* See if we have to do anything to INSN now that VAR is in
|
|
|
|
|
memory. If it needs to be loaded into a pseudo, use a single
|
|
|
|
|
pseudo for the entire insn in case there is a MATCH_DUP
|
|
|
|
|
between two operands. We pass a pointer to the head of
|
|
|
|
|
a list of struct fixup_replacements. If fixup_var_refs_1
|
|
|
|
|
needs to allocate pseudos or replacement MEMs (for SUBREGs),
|
|
|
|
|
it will record them in this list.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If it allocated a pseudo for any replacement, we copy into
|
|
|
|
|
it here. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_1 (var, promoted_mode, &PATTERN (insn), insn,
|
|
|
|
|
&replacements);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is last_parm_insn, and any instructions were output
|
|
|
|
|
after it to fix it up, then we must set last_parm_insn to
|
|
|
|
|
the last such instruction emitted. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (insn == last_parm_insn)
|
|
|
|
|
last_parm_insn = PREV_INSN (next_insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while (replacements)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement *next;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (replacements->new) == REG)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insert_before;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* OLD might be a (subreg (mem)). */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (replacements->old) == SUBREG)
|
|
|
|
|
replacements->old
|
|
|
|
|
= fixup_memory_subreg (replacements->old, insn, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
replacements->old
|
|
|
|
|
= fixup_stack_1 (replacements->old, insn);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insert_before = insn;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we are changing the mode, do a conversion.
|
|
|
|
|
This might be wasteful, but combine.c will
|
|
|
|
|
eliminate much of the waste. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (replacements->new)
|
|
|
|
|
!= GET_MODE (replacements->old))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
convert_move (replacements->new,
|
|
|
|
|
replacements->old, unsignedp);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_move_insn (replacements->new,
|
|
|
|
|
replacements->old);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (seq, insert_before);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
next = replacements->next;
|
|
|
|
|
free (replacements);
|
|
|
|
|
replacements = next;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Also fix up any invalid exprs in the REG_NOTES of this insn.
|
|
|
|
|
But don't touch other insns referred to by reg-notes;
|
|
|
|
|
we will get them elsewhere. */
|
|
|
|
|
while (note)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (note) != INSN_LIST)
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (note, 0)
|
|
|
|
|
= walk_fixup_memory_subreg (XEXP (note, 0), insn, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
note = XEXP (note, 1);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* VAR is a MEM that used to be a pseudo register with mode PROMOTED_MODE.
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
See if the rtx expression at *LOC in INSN needs to be changed.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
REPLACEMENTS is a pointer to a list head that starts out zero, but may
|
|
|
|
|
contain a list of original rtx's and replacements. If we find that we need
|
|
|
|
|
to modify this insn by replacing a memory reference with a pseudo or by
|
|
|
|
|
making a new MEM to implement a SUBREG, we consult that list to see if
|
|
|
|
|
we have already chosen a replacement. If none has already been allocated,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
we allocate it and update the list. fixup_var_refs_insn will copy VAR
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
or the SUBREG, as appropriate, to the pseudo. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_1 (var, promoted_mode, loc, insn, replacements)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx var;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx *loc;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement **replacements;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x = *loc;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
RTX_CODE code = GET_CODE (x);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
const char *fmt;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tem, tem1;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct fixup_replacement *replacement;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
switch (code)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
case ADDRESSOF:
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (x, 0) == var)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Prevent sharing of rtl that might lose. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx sub = copy_rtx (XEXP (var, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_change (insn, loc, sub, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx y = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (sub));
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq, new_insn;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* We should be able to replace with a register or all is lost.
|
|
|
|
|
Note that we can't use validate_change to verify this, since
|
|
|
|
|
we're not caring for replacing all dups simultaneously. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_replace_rtx (*loc, y, insn))
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Careful! First try to recognize a direct move of the
|
|
|
|
|
value, mimicking how things are done in gen_reload wrt
|
|
|
|
|
PLUS. Consider what happens when insn is a conditional
|
|
|
|
|
move instruction and addsi3 clobbers flags. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
new_insn = emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, y, sub));
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (recog_memoized (new_insn) < 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* That failed. Fall back on force_operand and hope. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
sub = force_operand (sub, y);
|
|
|
|
|
if (sub != y)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn (gen_move_insn (y, sub));
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_cc0
|
|
|
|
|
/* Don't separate setter from user. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (PREV_INSN (insn) && sets_cc0_p (PREV_INSN (insn)))
|
|
|
|
|
insn = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
case MEM:
|
|
|
|
|
if (var == x)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we already have a replacement, use it. Otherwise,
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
try to fix up this address in case it is invalid. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
replacement = find_fixup_replacement (replacements, var);
|
|
|
|
|
if (replacement->new)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = replacement->new;
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = replacement->new = x = fixup_stack_1 (x, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Unless we are forcing memory to register or we changed the mode,
|
|
|
|
|
we can leave things the way they are if the insn is valid. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
|
|
|
|
|
if (! flag_force_mem && GET_MODE (x) == promoted_mode
|
|
|
|
|
&& recog_memoized (insn) >= 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = replacement->new = gen_reg_rtx (promoted_mode);
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If X contains VAR, we need to unshare it here so that we update
|
|
|
|
|
each occurrence separately. But all identical MEMs in one insn
|
|
|
|
|
must be replaced with the same rtx because of the possibility of
|
|
|
|
|
MATCH_DUPs. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (reg_mentioned_p (var, x))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
replacement = find_fixup_replacement (replacements, x);
|
|
|
|
|
if (replacement->new == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
replacement->new = copy_most_rtx (x, var);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = x = replacement->new;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case REG:
|
|
|
|
|
case CC0:
|
|
|
|
|
case PC:
|
|
|
|
|
case CONST_INT:
|
|
|
|
|
case CONST:
|
|
|
|
|
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
|
|
|
|
case LABEL_REF:
|
|
|
|
|
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SIGN_EXTRACT:
|
|
|
|
|
case ZERO_EXTRACT:
|
|
|
|
|
/* Note that in some cases those types of expressions are altered
|
|
|
|
|
by optimize_bit_field, and do not survive to get here. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (x, 0) == var
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) == var))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Get TEM as a valid MEM in the mode presently in the insn.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We don't worry about the possibility of MATCH_DUP here; it
|
|
|
|
|
is highly unlikely and would be tricky to handle. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
tem = XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tem) == SUBREG)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (tem))
|
|
|
|
|
> GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (var)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
replacement = find_fixup_replacement (replacements, var);
|
|
|
|
|
if (replacement->new == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
replacement->new = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (var));
|
|
|
|
|
SUBREG_REG (tem) = replacement->new;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* The following code works only if we have a MEM, so we
|
|
|
|
|
need to handle the subreg here. We directly substitute
|
|
|
|
|
it assuming that a subreg must be OK here. We already
|
|
|
|
|
scheduled a replacement to copy the mem into the
|
|
|
|
|
subreg. */
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 0) = tem;
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
tem = fixup_memory_subreg (tem, insn, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
tem = fixup_stack_1 (tem, insn);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Unless we want to load from memory, get TEM into the proper mode
|
|
|
|
|
for an extract from memory. This can only be done if the
|
|
|
|
|
extract is at a constant position and length. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (! flag_force_mem && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 2)) == CONST_INT
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (tem, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (tem))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode wanted_mode = VOIDmode;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode is_mode = GET_MODE (tem);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT pos = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 2));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode new_mode
|
|
|
|
|
= mode_for_extraction (EP_extzv, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
if (new_mode != MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
|
|
|
|
|
wanted_mode = new_mode;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (x) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode new_mode
|
|
|
|
|
= mode_for_extraction (EP_extv, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
if (new_mode != MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
|
|
|
|
|
wanted_mode = new_mode;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a narrower mode, we can do something. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (wanted_mode != VOIDmode
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (wanted_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (is_mode))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = pos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx old_pos = XEXP (x, 2);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx newmem;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the bytes and bits are counted differently, we
|
|
|
|
|
must adjust the offset. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
|
|
|
|
offset = (GET_MODE_SIZE (is_mode)
|
|
|
|
|
- GET_MODE_SIZE (wanted_mode) - offset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pos %= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wanted_mode);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
newmem = adjust_address_nv (tem, wanted_mode, offset);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make the change and see if the insn remains valid. */
|
|
|
|
|
INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 0) = newmem;
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 2) = GEN_INT (pos);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise, restore old position. XEXP (x, 0) will be
|
|
|
|
|
restored later. */
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 2) = old_pos;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we get here, the bitfield extract insn can't accept a memory
|
|
|
|
|
reference. Copy the input into a register. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
tem1 = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (tem));
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_move_insn (tem1, tem), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 0) = tem1;
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
case SUBREG:
|
|
|
|
|
if (SUBREG_REG (x) == var)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a special SUBREG made because VAR was promoted
|
|
|
|
|
from a wider mode, replace it with VAR and call ourself
|
|
|
|
|
recursively, this time saying that the object previously
|
|
|
|
|
had its current mode (by virtue of the SUBREG). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = var;
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_1 (var, GET_MODE (var), loc, insn, replacements);
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this SUBREG makes VAR wider, it has become a paradoxical
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
SUBREG with VAR in memory, but these aren't allowed at this
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
stage of the compilation. So load VAR into a pseudo and take
|
|
|
|
|
a SUBREG of that pseudo. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (var)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
replacement = find_fixup_replacement (replacements, var);
|
|
|
|
|
if (replacement->new == 0)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
replacement->new = gen_reg_rtx (promoted_mode);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
SUBREG_REG (x) = replacement->new;
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* See if we have already found a replacement for this SUBREG.
|
|
|
|
|
If so, use it. Otherwise, make a MEM and see if the insn
|
|
|
|
|
is recognized. If not, or if we should force MEM into a register,
|
|
|
|
|
make a pseudo for this SUBREG. */
|
|
|
|
|
replacement = find_fixup_replacement (replacements, x);
|
|
|
|
|
if (replacement->new)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = replacement->new;
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
replacement->new = *loc = fixup_memory_subreg (x, insn, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
|
|
|
|
|
if (! flag_force_mem && recog_memoized (insn) >= 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = replacement->new = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (x));
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SET:
|
|
|
|
|
/* First do special simplification of bit-field references. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == SIGN_EXTRACT
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
|
|
|
|
optimize_bit_field (x, insn, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == SIGN_EXTRACT
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
optimize_bit_field (x, insn, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* For a paradoxical SUBREG inside a ZERO_EXTRACT, load the object
|
|
|
|
|
into a register and then store it back out. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == ZERO_EXTRACT
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& SUBREG_REG (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)) == var
|
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
> GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (var))))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
replacement = find_fixup_replacement (replacements, var);
|
|
|
|
|
if (replacement->new == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
replacement->new = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (var));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
SUBREG_REG (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)) = replacement->new;
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_after (gen_move_insn (var, replacement->new), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If SET_DEST is now a paradoxical SUBREG, put the result of this
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insn into a pseudo and store the low part of the pseudo into VAR. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (x)) == var
|
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (x)))
|
|
|
|
|
> GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (var))))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DEST (x) = tem = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (x)));
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_after (gen_move_insn (var, gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (var),
|
|
|
|
|
tem)),
|
|
|
|
|
insn);
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx dest = SET_DEST (x);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx outerdest = dest;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG || GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (dest) == SIGN_EXTRACT
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
|
|
|
|
dest = XEXP (dest, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
src = SUBREG_REG (src);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If VAR does not appear at the top level of the SET
|
|
|
|
|
just scan the lower levels of the tree. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (src != var && dest != var)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We will need to rerecognize this insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (outerdest) == ZERO_EXTRACT && dest == var
|
|
|
|
|
&& mode_for_extraction (EP_insv, -1) != MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Since this case will return, ensure we fixup all the
|
|
|
|
|
operands here. */
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_1 (var, promoted_mode, &XEXP (outerdest, 1),
|
|
|
|
|
insn, replacements);
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_1 (var, promoted_mode, &XEXP (outerdest, 2),
|
|
|
|
|
insn, replacements);
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_1 (var, promoted_mode, &SET_SRC (x),
|
|
|
|
|
insn, replacements);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
tem = XEXP (outerdest, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Clean up (SUBREG:SI (MEM:mode ...) 0)
|
|
|
|
|
that may appear inside a ZERO_EXTRACT.
|
|
|
|
|
This was legitimate when the MEM was a REG. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tem) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& SUBREG_REG (tem) == var)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tem = fixup_memory_subreg (tem, insn, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
tem = fixup_stack_1 (tem, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (outerdest, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (outerdest, 2)) == CONST_INT
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (tem, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (tem))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode wanted_mode;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode is_mode = GET_MODE (tem);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT pos = INTVAL (XEXP (outerdest, 2));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
wanted_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_insv, 0);
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a narrower mode, we can do something. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (wanted_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (is_mode))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = pos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx old_pos = XEXP (outerdest, 2);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx newmem;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
|
|
|
|
offset = (GET_MODE_SIZE (is_mode)
|
|
|
|
|
- GET_MODE_SIZE (wanted_mode) - offset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pos %= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wanted_mode);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
newmem = adjust_address_nv (tem, wanted_mode, offset);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make the change and see if the insn remains valid. */
|
|
|
|
|
INSN_CODE (insn) = -1;
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (outerdest, 0) = newmem;
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (outerdest, 2) = GEN_INT (pos);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise, restore old position. XEXP (x, 0) will be
|
|
|
|
|
restored later. */
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (outerdest, 2) = old_pos;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we get here, the bit-field store doesn't allow memory
|
|
|
|
|
or isn't located at a constant position. Load the value into
|
|
|
|
|
a register, do the store, and put it back into memory. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
tem1 = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (tem));
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_move_insn (tem1, tem), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_after (gen_move_insn (tem, tem1), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (outerdest, 0) = tem1;
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* STRICT_LOW_PART is a no-op on memory references
|
|
|
|
|
and it can cause combinations to be unrecognizable,
|
|
|
|
|
so eliminate it. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (dest == var && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DEST (x) = XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* A valid insn to copy VAR into or out of a register
|
|
|
|
|
must be left alone, to avoid an infinite loop here.
|
|
|
|
|
If the reference to VAR is by a subreg, fix that up,
|
|
|
|
|
since SUBREG is not valid for a memref.
|
|
|
|
|
Also fix up the address of the stack slot.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that we must not try to recognize the insn until
|
|
|
|
|
after we know that we have valid addresses and no
|
|
|
|
|
(subreg (mem ...) ...) constructs, since these interfere
|
|
|
|
|
with determining the validity of the insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((SET_SRC (x) == var
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& SUBREG_REG (SET_SRC (x)) == var))
|
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (x))) == REG))
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& GET_MODE (var) == promoted_mode
|
|
|
|
|
&& x == single_set (insn))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx pat, last;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
replacement = find_fixup_replacement (replacements, SET_SRC (x));
|
|
|
|
|
if (replacement->new)
|
|
|
|
|
SET_SRC (x) = replacement->new;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == SUBREG)
|
|
|
|
|
SET_SRC (x) = replacement->new
|
|
|
|
|
= fixup_memory_subreg (SET_SRC (x), insn, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
SET_SRC (x) = replacement->new
|
|
|
|
|
= fixup_stack_1 (SET_SRC (x), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* INSN is not valid, but we know that we want to
|
|
|
|
|
copy SET_SRC (x) to SET_DEST (x) in some way. So
|
|
|
|
|
we generate the move and see whether it requires more
|
|
|
|
|
than one insn. If it does, we emit those insns and
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
delete INSN. Otherwise, we an just replace the pattern
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
of INSN; we have already verified above that INSN has
|
|
|
|
|
no other function that to do X. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pat = gen_move_insn (SET_DEST (x), SET_SRC (x));
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) == SEQUENCE)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
last = emit_insn_before (pat, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* INSN might have REG_RETVAL or other important notes, so
|
|
|
|
|
we need to store the pattern of the last insn in the
|
|
|
|
|
sequence into INSN similarly to the normal case. LAST
|
|
|
|
|
should not have REG_NOTES, but we allow them if INSN has
|
|
|
|
|
no REG_NOTES. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (REG_NOTES (last) && REG_NOTES (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
if (REG_NOTES (last))
|
|
|
|
|
REG_NOTES (insn) = REG_NOTES (last);
|
|
|
|
|
PATTERN (insn) = PATTERN (last);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
delete_insn (last);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
PATTERN (insn) = pat;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((SET_DEST (x) == var
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (x)) == var))
|
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (SET_SRC (x))) == REG))
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& GET_MODE (var) == promoted_mode
|
|
|
|
|
&& x == single_set (insn))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx pat, last;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == SUBREG)
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DEST (x) = fixup_memory_subreg (SET_DEST (x), insn, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DEST (x) = fixup_stack_1 (SET_DEST (x), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pat = gen_move_insn (SET_DEST (x), SET_SRC (x));
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (pat) == SEQUENCE)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
last = emit_insn_before (pat, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* INSN might have REG_RETVAL or other important notes, so
|
|
|
|
|
we need to store the pattern of the last insn in the
|
|
|
|
|
sequence into INSN similarly to the normal case. LAST
|
|
|
|
|
should not have REG_NOTES, but we allow them if INSN has
|
|
|
|
|
no REG_NOTES. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (REG_NOTES (last) && REG_NOTES (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
if (REG_NOTES (last))
|
|
|
|
|
REG_NOTES (insn) = REG_NOTES (last);
|
|
|
|
|
PATTERN (insn) = PATTERN (last);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
delete_insn (last);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
PATTERN (insn) = pat;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise, storing into VAR must be handled specially
|
|
|
|
|
by storing into a temporary and copying that into VAR
|
|
|
|
|
with a new insn after this one. Note that this case
|
|
|
|
|
will be used when storing into a promoted scalar since
|
|
|
|
|
the insn will now have different modes on the input
|
|
|
|
|
and output and hence will be invalid (except for the case
|
|
|
|
|
of setting it to a constant, which does not need any
|
|
|
|
|
change if it is valid). We generate extra code in that case,
|
|
|
|
|
but combine.c will eliminate it. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (dest == var)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx temp;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx fixeddest = SET_DEST (x);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* STRICT_LOW_PART can be discarded, around a MEM. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (fixeddest) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
|
|
|
|
|
fixeddest = XEXP (fixeddest, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
/* Convert (SUBREG (MEM)) to a MEM in a changed mode. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (fixeddest) == SUBREG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
fixeddest = fixup_memory_subreg (fixeddest, insn, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
promoted_mode = GET_MODE (fixeddest);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
fixeddest = fixup_stack_1 (fixeddest, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
temp = gen_reg_rtx (promoted_mode);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_after (gen_move_insn (fixeddest,
|
|
|
|
|
gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (fixeddest),
|
|
|
|
|
temp)),
|
|
|
|
|
insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DEST (x) = temp;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Nothing special about this RTX; fix its operands. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_1 (var, promoted_mode, &XEXP (x, i), insn, replacements);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int j;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_1 (var, promoted_mode, &XVECEXP (x, i, j),
|
|
|
|
|
insn, replacements);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Given X, an rtx of the form (SUBREG:m1 (MEM:m2 addr)),
|
|
|
|
|
return an rtx (MEM:m1 newaddr) which is equivalent.
|
|
|
|
|
If any insns must be emitted to compute NEWADDR, put them before INSN.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UNCRITICAL nonzero means accept paradoxical subregs.
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
This is used for subregs found inside REG_NOTES. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_memory_subreg (x, insn, uncritical)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
int uncritical;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int offset = SUBREG_BYTE (x);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx addr = XEXP (SUBREG_REG (x), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx result;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Paradoxical SUBREGs are usually invalid during RTL generation. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! uncritical)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (!flag_force_addr
|
|
|
|
|
&& memory_address_p (mode, plus_constant (addr, offset)))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Shortcut if no insns need be emitted. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return adjust_address (SUBREG_REG (x), mode, offset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
result = adjust_address (SUBREG_REG (x), mode, offset);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_sequence (), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Do fixup_memory_subreg on all (SUBREG (MEM ...) ...) contained in X.
|
|
|
|
|
Replace subexpressions of X in place.
|
|
|
|
|
If X itself is a (SUBREG (MEM ...) ...), return the replacement expression.
|
|
|
|
|
Otherwise return X, with its contents possibly altered.
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
If any insns must be emitted to compute NEWADDR, put them before INSN.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UNCRITICAL is as in fixup_memory_subreg. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx
|
|
|
|
|
walk_fixup_memory_subreg (x, insn, uncritical)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
int uncritical;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum rtx_code code;
|
|
|
|
|
const char *fmt;
|
|
|
|
|
int i;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (x == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (code == SUBREG && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
return fixup_memory_subreg (x, insn, uncritical);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Nothing special about this RTX; fix its operands. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, i) = walk_fixup_memory_subreg (XEXP (x, i), insn, uncritical);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int j;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
|
|
|
|
XVECEXP (x, i, j)
|
|
|
|
|
= walk_fixup_memory_subreg (XVECEXP (x, i, j), insn, uncritical);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
return x;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* For each memory ref within X, if it refers to a stack slot
|
|
|
|
|
with an out of range displacement, put the address in a temp register
|
|
|
|
|
(emitting new insns before INSN to load these registers)
|
|
|
|
|
and alter the memory ref to use that register.
|
|
|
|
|
Replace each such MEM rtx with a copy, to avoid clobberage. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_stack_1 (x, insn)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
|
RTX_CODE code = GET_CODE (x);
|
|
|
|
|
const char *fmt;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (code == MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx ad = XEXP (x, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we have address of a stack slot but it's not valid
|
|
|
|
|
(displacement is too large), compute the sum in a register. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (ad) == PLUS
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (ad, 0)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& ((REGNO (XEXP (ad, 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
|
|
|
|
|
&& REGNO (XEXP (ad, 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| REGNO (XEXP (ad, 0)) == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
#if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
|| REGNO (XEXP (ad, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|| REGNO (XEXP (ad, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
|| REGNO (XEXP (ad, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| XEXP (ad, 0) == current_function_internal_arg_pointer)
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (ad, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx temp, seq;
|
|
|
|
|
if (memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), ad))
|
|
|
|
|
return x;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
temp = copy_to_reg (ad);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
return x;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (fmt[i] == 'e')
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, i) = fixup_stack_1 (XEXP (x, i), insn);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int j;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
|
|
|
|
XVECEXP (x, i, j) = fixup_stack_1 (XVECEXP (x, i, j), insn);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
return x;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Optimization: a bit-field instruction whose field
|
|
|
|
|
happens to be a byte or halfword in memory
|
|
|
|
|
can be changed to a move instruction.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We call here when INSN is an insn to examine or store into a bit-field.
|
|
|
|
|
BODY is the SET-rtx to be altered.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
EQUIV_MEM is the table `reg_equiv_mem' if that is available; else 0.
|
|
|
|
|
(Currently this is called only from function.c, and EQUIV_MEM
|
|
|
|
|
is always 0.) */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
optimize_bit_field (body, insn, equiv_mem)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx body;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx *equiv_mem;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx bitfield;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int destflag;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (body)) == SIGN_EXTRACT
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (SET_DEST (body)) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
|
|
|
|
|
bitfield = SET_DEST (body), destflag = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
bitfield = SET_SRC (body), destflag = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* First check that the field being stored has constant size and position
|
|
|
|
|
and is in fact a byte or halfword suitably aligned. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (bitfield, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (bitfield, 2)) == CONST_INT
|
|
|
|
|
&& ((mode = mode_for_size (INTVAL (XEXP (bitfield, 1)), MODE_INT, 1))
|
|
|
|
|
!= BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (bitfield, 2)) % INTVAL (XEXP (bitfield, 1)) == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx memref = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Now check that the containing word is memory, not a register,
|
|
|
|
|
and that it is safe to change the machine mode. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (bitfield, 0)) == MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
memref = XEXP (bitfield, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (bitfield, 0)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& equiv_mem != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
memref = equiv_mem[REGNO (XEXP (bitfield, 0))];
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (bitfield, 0)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (bitfield, 0))) == MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
memref = SUBREG_REG (XEXP (bitfield, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (bitfield, 0)) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& equiv_mem != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (bitfield, 0))) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
memref = equiv_mem[REGNO (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (bitfield, 0)))];
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (memref
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (memref, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (memref))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Now adjust the address, first for any subreg'ing
|
|
|
|
|
that we are now getting rid of,
|
|
|
|
|
and then for which byte of the word is wanted. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INTVAL (XEXP (bitfield, 2));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insns;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Adjust OFFSET to count bits from low-address byte. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN != BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
|
|
|
|
offset = (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (bitfield, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
- offset - INTVAL (XEXP (bitfield, 1)));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Adjust OFFSET to count bytes from low-address byte. */
|
|
|
|
|
offset /= BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (bitfield, 0)) == SUBREG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
offset += (SUBREG_BYTE (XEXP (bitfield, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
/ UNITS_PER_WORD) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
|
|
|
|
offset -= (MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD,
|
|
|
|
|
GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (bitfield, 0))))
|
|
|
|
|
- MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD,
|
|
|
|
|
GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (memref))));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
memref = adjust_address (memref, mode, offset);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insns = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insns_before (insns, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Store this memory reference where
|
|
|
|
|
we found the bit field reference. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (destflag)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (body), memref, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
if (! CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (SET_SRC (body)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx src = SET_SRC (body);
|
|
|
|
|
while (GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& SUBREG_BYTE (src) == 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
src = SUBREG_REG (src);
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (src) != GET_MODE (memref))
|
|
|
|
|
src = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (memref), SET_SRC (body));
|
|
|
|
|
validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (body), src, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_MODE (SET_SRC (body)) != VOIDmode
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_MODE (SET_SRC (body)) != GET_MODE (memref))
|
|
|
|
|
/* This shouldn't happen because anything that didn't have
|
|
|
|
|
one of these modes should have got converted explicitly
|
|
|
|
|
and then referenced through a subreg.
|
|
|
|
|
This is so because the original bit-field was
|
|
|
|
|
handled by agg_mode and so its tree structure had
|
|
|
|
|
the same mode that memref now has. */
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx dest = SET_DEST (body);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& SUBREG_BYTE (dest) == 0
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (dest))
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
== GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest))))
|
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest)))
|
|
|
|
|
<= UNITS_PER_WORD))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
validate_change (insn, &SET_DEST (body), dest, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (dest) == GET_MODE (memref))
|
|
|
|
|
validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (body), memref, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Convert the mem ref to the destination mode. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx newreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (dest));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
convert_move (newreg, memref,
|
|
|
|
|
GET_CODE (SET_SRC (body)) == ZERO_EXTRACT);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
validate_change (insn, &SET_SRC (body), newreg, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* See if we can convert this extraction or insertion into
|
|
|
|
|
a simple move insn. We might not be able to do so if this
|
|
|
|
|
was, for example, part of a PARALLEL.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If we succeed, write out any needed conversions. If we fail,
|
|
|
|
|
it is hard to guess why we failed, so don't do anything
|
|
|
|
|
special; just let the optimization be suppressed. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (apply_change_group () && seq)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insns_before (seq, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* These routines are responsible for converting virtual register references
|
|
|
|
|
to the actual hard register references once RTL generation is complete.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The following four variables are used for communication between the
|
|
|
|
|
routines. They contain the offsets of the virtual registers from their
|
|
|
|
|
respective hard registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int in_arg_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
static int var_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
static int dynamic_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
static int out_arg_offset;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static int cfa_offset;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* In most machines, the stack pointer register is equivalent to the bottom
|
|
|
|
|
of the stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
|
#define STACK_POINTER_OFFSET 0
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If not defined, pick an appropriate default for the offset of dynamically
|
|
|
|
|
allocated memory depending on the value of ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS,
|
|
|
|
|
REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE, and OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* The bottom of the stack points to the actual arguments. If
|
|
|
|
|
REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is defined, this includes the space for the register
|
|
|
|
|
parameters. However, if OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK space is not defined,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
stack space for register parameters is not pushed by the caller, but
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rather part of the fixed stack areas and hence not included in
|
|
|
|
|
`current_function_outgoing_args_size'. Nevertheless, we must allow
|
|
|
|
|
for it when allocating stack dynamic objects. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE) && ! defined(OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
|
|
|
|
|
#define STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET(FNDECL) \
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
((ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS \
|
|
|
|
|
? (current_function_outgoing_args_size + REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (FNDECL)) : 0)\
|
|
|
|
|
+ (STACK_POINTER_OFFSET)) \
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
#define STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET(FNDECL) \
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
((ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS ? current_function_outgoing_args_size : 0) \
|
|
|
|
|
+ (STACK_POINTER_OFFSET))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* On most machines, the CFA coincides with the first incoming parm. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#define ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET(FNDECL) FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (FNDECL)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Build up a (MEM (ADDRESSOF (REG))) rtx for a register REG that just had its
|
|
|
|
|
address taken. DECL is the decl or SAVE_EXPR for the object stored in the
|
|
|
|
|
register, for later use if we do need to force REG into the stack. REG is
|
|
|
|
|
overwritten by the MEM like in put_reg_into_stack. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
gen_mem_addressof (reg, decl)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx reg;
|
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx r = gen_rtx_ADDRESSOF (Pmode, gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg)),
|
|
|
|
|
REGNO (reg), decl);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Calculate this before we start messing with decl's RTL. */
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT set = decl ? get_alias_set (decl) : 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If the original REG was a user-variable, then so is the REG whose
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
address is being taken. Likewise for unchanging. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
REG_USERVAR_P (XEXP (r, 0)) = REG_USERVAR_P (reg);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
RTX_UNCHANGING_P (XEXP (r, 0)) = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (reg);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
PUT_CODE (reg, MEM);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
MEM_ATTRS (reg) = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (reg, 0) = r;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode decl_mode
|
|
|
|
|
= (DECL_P (decl) ? DECL_MODE (decl) : TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
|
|
|
|
|
rtx decl_rtl = (TREE_CODE (decl) == SAVE_EXPR ? SAVE_EXPR_RTL (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
: DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
PUT_MODE (reg, decl_mode);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Clear DECL_RTL momentarily so functions below will work
|
|
|
|
|
properly, then set it again. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_P (decl) && decl_rtl == reg)
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (decl, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (reg, decl, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_alias_set (reg, set);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_P (decl) && decl_rtl == reg)
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (decl, reg);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_USED (decl) || (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != 0))
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs (reg, GET_MODE (reg), TREE_UNSIGNED (type), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs (reg, GET_MODE (reg), 0, 0);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return reg;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If DECL has an RTL that is an ADDRESSOF rtx, put it into the stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
flush_addressof (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
|
|
|
|
|
&& DECL_RTL (decl) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (decl)) == MEM
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0)) == ADDRESSOF
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), 0)) == REG)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
put_addressof_into_stack (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), 0);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Force the register pointed to by R, an ADDRESSOF rtx, into the stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
put_addressof_into_stack (r, ht)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx r;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree decl, type;
|
|
|
|
|
int volatile_p, used_p;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx reg = XEXP (r, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg) != REG)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
decl = ADDRESSOF_DECL (r);
|
|
|
|
|
if (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
|
|
|
|
|
volatile_p = (TREE_CODE (decl) != SAVE_EXPR
|
|
|
|
|
&& TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl));
|
|
|
|
|
used_p = (TREE_USED (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
|| (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != 0));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
type = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
volatile_p = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
used_p = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
put_reg_into_stack (0, reg, type, GET_MODE (reg), GET_MODE (reg),
|
|
|
|
|
volatile_p, ADDRESSOF_REGNO (r), used_p, ht);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* List of replacements made below in purge_addressof_1 when creating
|
|
|
|
|
bitfield insertions. */
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx purge_bitfield_addressof_replacements;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* List of replacements made below in purge_addressof_1 for patterns
|
|
|
|
|
(MEM (ADDRESSOF (REG ...))). The key of the list entry is the
|
|
|
|
|
corresponding (ADDRESSOF (REG ...)) and value is a substitution for
|
|
|
|
|
the all pattern. List PURGE_BITFIELD_ADDRESSOF_REPLACEMENTS is not
|
|
|
|
|
enough in complex cases, e.g. when some field values can be
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
extracted by usage MEM with narrower mode. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static rtx purge_addressof_replacements;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Helper function for purge_addressof. See if the rtx expression at *LOC
|
|
|
|
|
in INSN needs to be changed. If FORCE, always put any ADDRESSOFs into
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
the stack. If the function returns FALSE then the replacement could not
|
|
|
|
|
be made. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
purge_addressof_1 (loc, insn, force, store, ht)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx *loc;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int force, store;
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
RTX_CODE code;
|
|
|
|
|
int i, j;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
const char *fmt;
|
|
|
|
|
bool result = true;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Re-start here to avoid recursion in common cases. */
|
|
|
|
|
restart:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
x = *loc;
|
|
|
|
|
if (x == 0)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we don't return in any of the cases below, we will recurse inside
|
|
|
|
|
the RTX, which will normally result in any ADDRESSOF being forced into
|
|
|
|
|
memory. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (code == SET)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
result = purge_addressof_1 (&SET_DEST (x), insn, force, 1, ht);
|
|
|
|
|
result &= purge_addressof_1 (&SET_SRC (x), insn, force, 0, ht);
|
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (code == ADDRESSOF)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx sub, insns;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
put_addressof_into_stack (x, ht);
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* We must create a copy of the rtx because it was created by
|
|
|
|
|
overwriting a REG rtx which is always shared. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
sub = copy_rtx (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (validate_change (insn, loc, sub, 0)
|
|
|
|
|
|| validate_replace_rtx (x, sub, insn))
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
sub = force_operand (sub, NULL_RTX);
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_change (insn, loc, sub, 0)
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! validate_replace_rtx (x, sub, insn))
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insns = gen_sequence ();
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (insns, insn);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (code == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ADDRESSOF && ! force)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx sub = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (sub) == MEM)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
sub = adjust_address_nv (sub, GET_MODE (x), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (sub) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& (MEM_VOLATILE_P (x) || GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode))
|
|
|
|
|
;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (sub) == REG && GET_MODE (x) != GET_MODE (sub))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int size_x, size_sub;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!insn)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* When processing REG_NOTES look at the list of
|
|
|
|
|
replacements done on the insn to find the register that X
|
|
|
|
|
was replaced by. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tem;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (tem = purge_bitfield_addressof_replacements;
|
|
|
|
|
tem != NULL_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
tem = XEXP (XEXP (tem, 1), 1))
|
|
|
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (x, XEXP (tem, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = XEXP (XEXP (tem, 1), 0);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* See comment for purge_addressof_replacements. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (tem = purge_addressof_replacements;
|
|
|
|
|
tem != NULL_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
tem = XEXP (XEXP (tem, 1), 1))
|
|
|
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (tem, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx z = XEXP (XEXP (tem, 1), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (z)
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (tem, 1), 0)) != REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (tem, 1), 0)) != SUBREG))
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* It can happen that the note may speak of things
|
|
|
|
|
in a wider (or just different) mode than the
|
|
|
|
|
code did. This is especially true of
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
REG_RETVAL. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (z) == SUBREG && SUBREG_BYTE (z) == 0)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
z = SUBREG_REG (z);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > UNITS_PER_WORD
|
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
|
|
|
|
|
> GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (z))))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* This can occur as a result in invalid
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
pointer casts, e.g. float f; ...
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
*(long long int *)&f.
|
|
|
|
|
??? We could emit a warning here, but
|
|
|
|
|
without a line number that wouldn't be
|
|
|
|
|
very helpful. */
|
|
|
|
|
z = gen_rtx_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), z, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
z = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (x), z);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = z;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Sometimes we may not be able to find the replacement. For
|
|
|
|
|
example when the original insn was a MEM in a wider mode,
|
|
|
|
|
and the note is part of a sign extension of a narrowed
|
|
|
|
|
version of that MEM. Gcc testcase compile/990829-1.c can
|
|
|
|
|
generate an example of this situation. Rather than complain
|
|
|
|
|
we return false, which will prompt our caller to remove the
|
|
|
|
|
offending note. */
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
size_x = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x));
|
|
|
|
|
size_sub = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (sub));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Don't even consider working with paradoxical subregs,
|
|
|
|
|
or the moral equivalent seen here. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (size_x <= size_sub
|
|
|
|
|
&& int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (sub)) != BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Do a bitfield insertion to mirror what would happen
|
|
|
|
|
in memory. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx val, seq;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (store)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx p = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
val = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (x));
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_change (insn, loc, val, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Discard the current sequence and put the
|
|
|
|
|
ADDRESSOF on stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
goto give_up;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
compute_insns_for_mem (p ? NEXT_INSN (p) : get_insns (),
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insn, ht);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
store_bit_field (sub, size_x, 0, GET_MODE (x),
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
val, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (sub)));
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure to unshare any shared rtl that store_bit_field
|
|
|
|
|
might have created. */
|
2001-02-17 08:35:00 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unshare_all_rtl_again (get_insns ());
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
p = emit_insn_after (seq, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
if (NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
compute_insns_for_mem (NEXT_INSN (insn),
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
p ? NEXT_INSN (p) : NULL_RTX,
|
|
|
|
|
ht);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx p = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
val = extract_bit_field (sub, size_x, 0, 1, NULL_RTX,
|
|
|
|
|
GET_MODE (x), GET_MODE (x),
|
|
|
|
|
GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (sub)));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_change (insn, loc, val, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Discard the current sequence and put the
|
|
|
|
|
ADDRESSOF on stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
goto give_up;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
compute_insns_for_mem (p ? NEXT_INSN (p) : get_insns (),
|
|
|
|
|
insn, ht);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Remember the replacement so that the same one can be done
|
|
|
|
|
on the REG_NOTES. */
|
|
|
|
|
purge_bitfield_addressof_replacements
|
|
|
|
|
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x,
|
|
|
|
|
gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST
|
|
|
|
|
(VOIDmode, val,
|
|
|
|
|
purge_bitfield_addressof_replacements));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We replaced with a reg -- all done. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (validate_change (insn, loc, sub, 0))
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Remember the replacement so that the same one can be done
|
|
|
|
|
on the REG_NOTES. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (sub) == REG || GET_CODE (sub) == SUBREG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tem;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (tem = purge_addressof_replacements;
|
|
|
|
|
tem != NULL_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
tem = XEXP (XEXP (tem, 1), 1))
|
|
|
|
|
if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (tem, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (XEXP (tem, 1), 0) = sub;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
purge_addressof_replacements
|
|
|
|
|
= gen_rtx (EXPR_LIST, VOIDmode, XEXP (x, 0),
|
|
|
|
|
gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, sub,
|
|
|
|
|
purge_addressof_replacements));
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
goto restart;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
give_up:
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan all subexpressions. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (*fmt == 'e')
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
result &= purge_addressof_1 (&XEXP (x, i), insn, force, 0, ht);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (*fmt == 'E')
|
|
|
|
|
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
result &= purge_addressof_1 (&XVECEXP (x, i, j), insn, force, 0, ht);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return result;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Return a new hash table entry in HT. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static struct hash_entry *
|
|
|
|
|
insns_for_mem_newfunc (he, ht, k)
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_entry *he;
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
|
|
|
|
hash_table_key k ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct insns_for_mem_entry *ifmhe;
|
|
|
|
|
if (he)
|
|
|
|
|
return he;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ifmhe = ((struct insns_for_mem_entry *)
|
|
|
|
|
hash_allocate (ht, sizeof (struct insns_for_mem_entry)));
|
|
|
|
|
ifmhe->insns = NULL_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return &ifmhe->he;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return a hash value for K, a REG. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static unsigned long
|
|
|
|
|
insns_for_mem_hash (k)
|
|
|
|
|
hash_table_key k;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* K is really a RTX. Just use the address as the hash value. */
|
|
|
|
|
return (unsigned long) k;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return non-zero if K1 and K2 (two REGs) are the same. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static bool
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insns_for_mem_comp (k1, k2)
|
|
|
|
|
hash_table_key k1;
|
|
|
|
|
hash_table_key k2;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
return k1 == k2;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct insns_for_mem_walk_info
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The hash table that we are using to record which INSNs use which
|
|
|
|
|
MEMs. */
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The INSN we are currently processing. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Zero if we are walking to find ADDRESSOFs, one if we are walking
|
|
|
|
|
to find the insns that use the REGs in the ADDRESSOFs. */
|
|
|
|
|
int pass;
|
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Called from compute_insns_for_mem via for_each_rtx. If R is a REG
|
|
|
|
|
that might be used in an ADDRESSOF expression, record this INSN in
|
|
|
|
|
the hash table given by DATA (which is really a pointer to an
|
|
|
|
|
insns_for_mem_walk_info structure). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
|
|
|
insns_for_mem_walk (r, data)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx *r;
|
|
|
|
|
void *data;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct insns_for_mem_walk_info *ifmwi
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
= (struct insns_for_mem_walk_info *) data;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (ifmwi->pass == 0 && *r && GET_CODE (*r) == ADDRESSOF
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (*r, 0)) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
hash_lookup (ifmwi->ht, XEXP (*r, 0), /*create=*/1, /*copy=*/0);
|
|
|
|
|
else if (ifmwi->pass == 1 && *r && GET_CODE (*r) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Lookup this MEM in the hashtable, creating it if necessary. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct insns_for_mem_entry *ifme
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
= (struct insns_for_mem_entry *) hash_lookup (ifmwi->ht,
|
|
|
|
|
*r,
|
|
|
|
|
/*create=*/0,
|
|
|
|
|
/*copy=*/0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we have not already recorded this INSN, do so now. Since
|
|
|
|
|
we process the INSNs in order, we know that if we have
|
|
|
|
|
recorded it it must be at the front of the list. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (ifme && (!ifme->insns || XEXP (ifme->insns, 0) != ifmwi->insn))
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
ifme->insns = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, ifmwi->insn,
|
|
|
|
|
ifme->insns);
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Walk the INSNS, until we reach LAST_INSN, recording which INSNs use
|
|
|
|
|
which REGs in HT. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
compute_insns_for_mem (insns, last_insn, ht)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insns;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx last_insn;
|
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table *ht;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
struct insns_for_mem_walk_info ifmwi;
|
|
|
|
|
ifmwi.ht = ht;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (ifmwi.pass = 0; ifmwi.pass < 2; ++ifmwi.pass)
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = insns; insn != last_insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (INSN_P (insn))
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
ifmwi.insn = insn;
|
|
|
|
|
for_each_rtx (&insn, insns_for_mem_walk, &ifmwi);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Helper function for purge_addressof called through for_each_rtx.
|
|
|
|
|
Returns true iff the rtl is an ADDRESSOF. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
|
|
|
is_addressof (rtl, data)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx *rtl;
|
|
|
|
|
void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
return GET_CODE (*rtl) == ADDRESSOF;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Eliminate all occurrences of ADDRESSOF from INSNS. Elide any remaining
|
|
|
|
|
(MEM (ADDRESSOF)) patterns, and force any needed registers into the
|
|
|
|
|
stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
purge_addressof (insns)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insns;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct hash_table ht;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* When we actually purge ADDRESSOFs, we turn REGs into MEMs. That
|
|
|
|
|
requires a fixup pass over the instruction stream to correct
|
|
|
|
|
INSNs that depended on the REG being a REG, and not a MEM. But,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
these fixup passes are slow. Furthermore, most MEMs are not
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mentioned in very many instructions. So, we speed up the process
|
|
|
|
|
by pre-calculating which REGs occur in which INSNs; that allows
|
|
|
|
|
us to perform the fixup passes much more quickly. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
hash_table_init (&ht,
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insns_for_mem_newfunc,
|
|
|
|
|
insns_for_mem_hash,
|
|
|
|
|
insns_for_mem_comp);
|
|
|
|
|
compute_insns_for_mem (insns, NULL_RTX, &ht);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (insn = insns; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (! purge_addressof_1 (&PATTERN (insn), insn,
|
|
|
|
|
asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) > 0, 0, &ht))
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we could not replace the ADDRESSOFs in the insn,
|
|
|
|
|
something is wrong. */
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (! purge_addressof_1 (®_NOTES (insn), NULL_RTX, 0, 0, &ht))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we could not replace the ADDRESSOFs in the insn's notes,
|
|
|
|
|
we can just remove the offending notes instead. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx note;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we find a REG_RETVAL note then the insn is a libcall.
|
|
|
|
|
Such insns must have REG_EQUAL notes as well, in order
|
|
|
|
|
for later passes of the compiler to work. So it is not
|
|
|
|
|
safe to delete the notes here, and instead we abort. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_RETVAL)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
if (for_each_rtx (¬e, is_addressof, NULL))
|
|
|
|
|
remove_note (insn, note);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Clean up. */
|
|
|
|
|
hash_table_free (&ht);
|
|
|
|
|
purge_bitfield_addressof_replacements = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
purge_addressof_replacements = 0;
|
2001-02-17 08:35:00 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* REGs are shared. purge_addressof will destructively replace a REG
|
|
|
|
|
with a MEM, which creates shared MEMs.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Unfortunately, the children of put_reg_into_stack assume that MEMs
|
|
|
|
|
referring to the same stack slot are shared (fixup_var_refs and
|
|
|
|
|
the associated hash table code).
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
So, we have to do another unsharing pass after we have flushed any
|
|
|
|
|
REGs that had their address taken into the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It may be worth tracking whether or not we converted any REGs into
|
|
|
|
|
MEMs to avoid this overhead when it is not needed. */
|
|
|
|
|
unshare_all_rtl_again (get_insns ());
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Convert a SET of a hard subreg to a set of the appropriate hard
|
|
|
|
|
register. A subroutine of purge_hard_subreg_sets. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
purge_single_hard_subreg_set (pattern)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx pattern;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx reg = SET_DEST (pattern);
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (SET_DEST (pattern));
|
|
|
|
|
int offset = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (reg)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& REGNO (SUBREG_REG (reg)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
offset = subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (SUBREG_REG (reg)),
|
|
|
|
|
GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (reg)),
|
|
|
|
|
SUBREG_BYTE (reg),
|
|
|
|
|
GET_MODE (reg));
|
|
|
|
|
reg = SUBREG_REG (reg);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg) == REG && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
reg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, REGNO (reg) + offset);
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DEST (pattern) = reg;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Eliminate all occurrences of SETs of hard subregs from INSNS. The
|
|
|
|
|
only such SETs that we expect to see are those left in because
|
|
|
|
|
integrate can't handle sets of parts of a return value register.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We don't use alter_subreg because we only want to eliminate subregs
|
|
|
|
|
of hard registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
purge_hard_subreg_sets (insn)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (INSN_P (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx pattern = PATTERN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
switch (GET_CODE (pattern))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
case SET:
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (pattern)) == SUBREG)
|
|
|
|
|
purge_single_hard_subreg_set (pattern);
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
case PARALLEL:
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int j;
|
|
|
|
|
for (j = XVECLEN (pattern, 0) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx inner_pattern = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, j);
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (inner_pattern) == SET
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SET_DEST (inner_pattern)) == SUBREG)
|
|
|
|
|
purge_single_hard_subreg_set (inner_pattern);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Pass through the INSNS of function FNDECL and convert virtual register
|
|
|
|
|
references to hard register references. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs (fndecl, insns)
|
|
|
|
|
tree fndecl;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insns;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unsigned int i;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the offsets to use for this function. */
|
|
|
|
|
in_arg_offset = FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fndecl);
|
|
|
|
|
var_offset = STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET;
|
|
|
|
|
dynamic_offset = STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (fndecl);
|
|
|
|
|
out_arg_offset = STACK_POINTER_OFFSET;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
cfa_offset = ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (fndecl);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan all variables and parameters of this function. For each that is
|
|
|
|
|
in memory, instantiate all virtual registers if the result is a valid
|
|
|
|
|
address. If not, we do it later. That will handle most uses of virtual
|
|
|
|
|
regs on many machines. */
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decls (fndecl, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize recognition, indicating that volatile is OK. */
|
|
|
|
|
init_recog ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan through all the insns, instantiating every virtual register still
|
|
|
|
|
present. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = insns; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&PATTERN (insn), insn, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (®_NOTES (insn), NULL_RTX, 0);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Instantiate any virtual registers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn),
|
|
|
|
|
NULL_RTX, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Instantiate the stack slots for the parm registers, for later use in
|
|
|
|
|
addressof elimination. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < max_parm_reg; ++i)
|
|
|
|
|
if (parm_reg_stack_loc[i])
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&parm_reg_stack_loc[i], NULL_RTX, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Now instantiate the remaining register equivalences for debugging info.
|
|
|
|
|
These will not be valid addresses. */
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decls (fndecl, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate that, from now on, assign_stack_local should use
|
|
|
|
|
frame_pointer_rtx. */
|
|
|
|
|
virtuals_instantiated = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan all decls in FNDECL (both variables and parameters) and instantiate
|
|
|
|
|
all virtual registers in their DECL_RTL's.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If VALID_ONLY, do this only if the resulting address is still valid.
|
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, always do it. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decls (fndecl, valid_only)
|
|
|
|
|
tree fndecl;
|
|
|
|
|
int valid_only;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Process all parameters of the function. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size_rtl;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decl (DECL_RTL (decl), size, valid_only);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the parameter was promoted, then the incoming RTL mode may be
|
|
|
|
|
larger than the declared type size. We must use the larger of
|
|
|
|
|
the two sizes. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
size_rtl = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)));
|
|
|
|
|
size = MAX (size_rtl, size);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decl (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl), size, valid_only);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Now process all variables defined in the function or its subblocks. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decls_1 (DECL_INITIAL (fndecl), valid_only);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Subroutine of instantiate_decls: Process all decls in the given
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK node and all its subblocks. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decls_1 (let, valid_only)
|
|
|
|
|
tree let;
|
|
|
|
|
int valid_only;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree t;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (t = BLOCK_VARS (let); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (t))
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decl (DECL_RTL (t),
|
|
|
|
|
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (t)),
|
|
|
|
|
valid_only);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Process all subblocks. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (t = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (let); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decls_1 (t, valid_only);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Subroutine of the preceding procedures: Given RTL representing a
|
|
|
|
|
decl and the size of the object, do any instantiation required.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If VALID_ONLY is non-zero, it means that the RTL should only be
|
|
|
|
|
changed if the new address is valid. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_decl (x, size, valid_only)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT size;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int valid_only;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx addr;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is not a MEM, no need to do anything. Similarly if the
|
|
|
|
|
address is a constant or a register that is not a virtual register. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (x == 0 || GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
addr = XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
if (CONSTANT_P (addr)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (addr) == ADDRESSOF && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == REG)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (addr) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& (REGNO (addr) < FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
|
|
|
|
|
|| REGNO (addr) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)))
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we should only do this if the address is valid, copy the address.
|
|
|
|
|
We need to do this so we can undo any changes that might make the
|
|
|
|
|
address invalid. This copy is unfortunate, but probably can't be
|
|
|
|
|
avoided. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (valid_only)
|
|
|
|
|
addr = copy_rtx (addr);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&addr, NULL_RTX, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (valid_only && size >= 0)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size = size;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Now verify that the resulting address is valid for every integer or
|
|
|
|
|
floating-point mode up to and including SIZE bytes long. We do this
|
|
|
|
|
since the object might be accessed in any mode and frame addresses
|
|
|
|
|
are shared. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= decl_size;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
|
|
|
|
|
if (! memory_address_p (mode, addr))
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= decl_size;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
|
|
|
|
|
if (! memory_address_p (mode, addr))
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Put back the address now that we have updated it and we either know
|
|
|
|
|
it is valid or we don't care whether it is valid. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 0) = addr;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Given a piece of RTX and a pointer to a HOST_WIDE_INT, if the RTX
|
|
|
|
|
is a virtual register, return the equivalent hard register and set the
|
|
|
|
|
offset indirectly through the pointer. Otherwise, return 0. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_new_reg (x, poffset)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT *poffset;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx new;
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (x == virtual_incoming_args_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
new = arg_pointer_rtx, offset = in_arg_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (x == virtual_stack_vars_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
new = frame_pointer_rtx, offset = var_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (x == virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
new = stack_pointer_rtx, offset = dynamic_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (x == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
new = stack_pointer_rtx, offset = out_arg_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (x == virtual_cfa_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
new = arg_pointer_rtx, offset = cfa_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*poffset = offset;
|
|
|
|
|
return new;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Given a pointer to a piece of rtx and an optional pointer to the
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
containing object, instantiate any virtual registers present in it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If EXTRA_INSNS, we always do the replacement and generate
|
|
|
|
|
any extra insns before OBJECT. If it zero, we do nothing if replacement
|
|
|
|
|
is not valid.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Return 1 if we either had nothing to do or if we were able to do the
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
needed replacement. Return 0 otherwise; we only return zero if
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
EXTRA_INSNS is zero.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We first try some simple transformations to avoid the creation of extra
|
|
|
|
|
pseudos. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (loc, object, extra_insns)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx *loc;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx object;
|
|
|
|
|
int extra_insns;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
RTX_CODE code;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx new = 0;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx temp;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq;
|
|
|
|
|
int i, j;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
const char *fmt;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Re-start here to avoid recursion in common cases. */
|
|
|
|
|
restart:
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
x = *loc;
|
|
|
|
|
if (x == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
code = GET_CODE (x);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Check for some special cases. */
|
|
|
|
|
switch (code)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
case CONST_INT:
|
|
|
|
|
case CONST_DOUBLE:
|
|
|
|
|
case CONST:
|
|
|
|
|
case SYMBOL_REF:
|
|
|
|
|
case CODE_LABEL:
|
|
|
|
|
case PC:
|
|
|
|
|
case CC0:
|
|
|
|
|
case ASM_INPUT:
|
|
|
|
|
case ADDR_VEC:
|
|
|
|
|
case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
|
|
|
|
|
case RETURN:
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SET:
|
|
|
|
|
/* We are allowed to set the virtual registers. This means that
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
the actual register should receive the source minus the
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
appropriate offset. This is used, for example, in the handling
|
|
|
|
|
of non-local gotos. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if ((new = instantiate_new_reg (SET_DEST (x), &offset)) != 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We are setting the register, not using it, so the relevant
|
|
|
|
|
offset is the negative of the offset to use were we using
|
|
|
|
|
the register. */
|
|
|
|
|
offset = - offset;
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&src, NULL_RTX, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The only valid sources here are PLUS or REG. Just do
|
|
|
|
|
the simplest possible thing to handle them. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (src) != REG && GET_CODE (src) != PLUS)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (src) != REG)
|
|
|
|
|
temp = force_operand (src, NULL_RTX);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
temp = src;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
temp = force_operand (plus_constant (temp, offset), NULL_RTX);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insns_before (seq, object);
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DEST (x) = new;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_change (object, &SET_SRC (x), temp, 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| ! extra_insns)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&SET_DEST (x), object, extra_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
loc = &SET_SRC (x);
|
|
|
|
|
goto restart;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case PLUS:
|
|
|
|
|
/* Handle special case of virtual register plus constant. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx old, new_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Check for (plus (plus VIRT foo) (const_int)) first. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if ((new = instantiate_new_reg (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), &offset)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1), object,
|
|
|
|
|
extra_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
new = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, new, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
loc = &XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
goto restart;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we have (plus (subreg (virtual-reg)) (const_int)), we know
|
|
|
|
|
we can commute the PLUS and SUBREG because pointers into the
|
|
|
|
|
frame are well-behaved. */
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG && GET_MODE (x) == ptr_mode
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
|
|
|
|
|
&& 0 != (new
|
|
|
|
|
= instantiate_new_reg (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)),
|
|
|
|
|
&offset))
|
|
|
|
|
&& validate_change (object, loc,
|
|
|
|
|
plus_constant (gen_lowpart (ptr_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
new),
|
|
|
|
|
offset
|
|
|
|
|
+ INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))),
|
|
|
|
|
0))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
else if ((new = instantiate_new_reg (XEXP (x, 0), &offset)) == 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* We know the second operand is a constant. Unless the
|
|
|
|
|
first operand is a REG (which has been already checked),
|
|
|
|
|
it needs to be checked. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != REG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
loc = &XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
goto restart;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
new_offset = plus_constant (XEXP (x, 1), offset);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the new constant is zero, try to replace the sum with just
|
|
|
|
|
the register. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (new_offset == const0_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
&& validate_change (object, loc, new, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Next try to replace the register and new offset.
|
|
|
|
|
There are two changes to validate here and we can't assume that
|
|
|
|
|
in the case of old offset equals new just changing the register
|
|
|
|
|
will yield a valid insn. In the interests of a little efficiency,
|
|
|
|
|
however, we only call validate change once (we don't queue up the
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
changes and then call apply_change_group). */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
old = XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
if (offset == 0
|
|
|
|
|
? ! validate_change (object, &XEXP (x, 0), new, 0)
|
|
|
|
|
: (XEXP (x, 0) = new,
|
|
|
|
|
! validate_change (object, &XEXP (x, 1), new_offset, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (! extra_insns)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 0) = old;
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise copy the new constant into a register and replace
|
|
|
|
|
constant with that register. */
|
|
|
|
|
temp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 0) = new;
|
|
|
|
|
if (validate_change (object, &XEXP (x, 1), temp, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (gen_move_insn (temp, new_offset), object);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If that didn't work, replace this expression with a
|
|
|
|
|
register containing the sum. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 0) = old;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
new = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, new, new_offset);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
temp = force_operand (new, NULL_RTX);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insns_before (seq, object);
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_change (object, loc, temp, 0)
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! validate_replace_rtx (x, temp, object))
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Fall through to generic two-operand expression case. */
|
|
|
|
|
case EXPR_LIST:
|
|
|
|
|
case CALL:
|
|
|
|
|
case COMPARE:
|
|
|
|
|
case MINUS:
|
|
|
|
|
case MULT:
|
|
|
|
|
case DIV: case UDIV:
|
|
|
|
|
case MOD: case UMOD:
|
|
|
|
|
case AND: case IOR: case XOR:
|
|
|
|
|
case ROTATERT: case ROTATE:
|
|
|
|
|
case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFT:
|
|
|
|
|
case NE: case EQ:
|
|
|
|
|
case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
|
|
|
|
|
case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (x, 1) && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&XEXP (x, 1), object, extra_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
loc = &XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
goto restart;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case MEM:
|
|
|
|
|
/* Most cases of MEM that convert to valid addresses have already been
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
handled by our scan of decls. The only special handling we
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
need here is to make a copy of the rtx to ensure it isn't being
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
shared if we have to change it to a pseudo.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If the rtx is a simple reference to an address via a virtual register,
|
|
|
|
|
it can potentially be shared. In such cases, first try to make it
|
|
|
|
|
a valid address, which can also be shared. Otherwise, copy it and
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
proceed normally.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
First check for common cases that need no processing. These are
|
|
|
|
|
usually due to instantiation already being done on a previous instance
|
|
|
|
|
of a shared rtx. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
temp = XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
if (CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (temp)
|
|
|
|
|
#if FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
|| temp == arg_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
#if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
|| temp == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|| temp == frame_pointer_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (temp) == PLUS
|
|
|
|
|
&& CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (temp, 1))
|
|
|
|
|
&& (XEXP (temp, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
#if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
|| XEXP (temp, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
#if FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
|| XEXP (temp, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (temp == virtual_stack_vars_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
|| temp == virtual_incoming_args_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (temp) == PLUS
|
|
|
|
|
&& CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (temp, 1))
|
|
|
|
|
&& (XEXP (temp, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
|| XEXP (temp, 0) == virtual_incoming_args_rtx)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* This MEM may be shared. If the substitution can be done without
|
|
|
|
|
the need to generate new pseudos, we want to do it in place
|
|
|
|
|
so all copies of the shared rtx benefit. The call below will
|
|
|
|
|
only make substitutions if the resulting address is still
|
|
|
|
|
valid.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Note that we cannot pass X as the object in the recursive call
|
|
|
|
|
since the insn being processed may not allow all valid
|
|
|
|
|
addresses. However, if we were not passed on object, we can
|
|
|
|
|
only modify X without copying it if X will have a valid
|
|
|
|
|
address.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
??? Also note that this can still lose if OBJECT is an insn that
|
|
|
|
|
has less restrictions on an address that some other insn.
|
|
|
|
|
In that case, we will modify the shared address. This case
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
doesn't seem very likely, though. One case where this could
|
|
|
|
|
happen is in the case of a USE or CLOBBER reference, but we
|
|
|
|
|
take care of that below. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&XEXP (x, 0),
|
|
|
|
|
object ? object : x, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise make a copy and process that copy. We copy the entire
|
|
|
|
|
RTL expression since it might be a PLUS which could also be
|
|
|
|
|
shared. */
|
|
|
|
|
*loc = x = copy_rtx (x);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Fall through to generic unary operation case. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
case PREFETCH:
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
case SUBREG:
|
|
|
|
|
case STRICT_LOW_PART:
|
|
|
|
|
case NEG: case NOT:
|
|
|
|
|
case PRE_DEC: case PRE_INC: case POST_DEC: case POST_INC:
|
|
|
|
|
case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
|
|
|
|
|
case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
|
|
|
|
|
case FLOAT: case FIX:
|
|
|
|
|
case UNSIGNED_FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
|
|
|
|
|
case ABS:
|
|
|
|
|
case SQRT:
|
|
|
|
|
case FFS:
|
|
|
|
|
/* These case either have just one operand or we know that we need not
|
|
|
|
|
check the rest of the operands. */
|
|
|
|
|
loc = &XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
goto restart;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
case USE:
|
|
|
|
|
case CLOBBER:
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the operand is a MEM, see if the change is a valid MEM. If not,
|
|
|
|
|
go ahead and make the invalid one, but do it to a copy. For a REG,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
just make the recursive call, since there's no chance of a problem. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM
|
|
|
|
|
&& instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), XEXP (x, 0),
|
|
|
|
|
0))
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&XEXP (x, 0), object, 0)))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
XEXP (x, 0) = copy_rtx (XEXP (x, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
loc = &XEXP (x, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
goto restart;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
case REG:
|
|
|
|
|
/* Try to replace with a PLUS. If that doesn't work, compute the sum
|
|
|
|
|
in front of this insn and substitute the temporary. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if ((new = instantiate_new_reg (x, &offset)) != 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
temp = plus_constant (new, offset);
|
|
|
|
|
if (!validate_change (object, loc, temp, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (! extra_insns)
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
temp = force_operand (temp, NULL_RTX);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insns_before (seq, object);
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_change (object, loc, temp, 0)
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! validate_replace_rtx (x, temp, object))
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case ADDRESSOF:
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a (addressof (mem ..)), do any instantiation inside
|
|
|
|
|
since we know we'll be making the inside valid when we finally
|
|
|
|
|
remove the ADDRESSOF. */
|
|
|
|
|
instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), NULL_RTX, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan all subexpressions. */
|
|
|
|
|
fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++, fmt++)
|
|
|
|
|
if (*fmt == 'e')
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (!instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&XEXP (x, i), object, extra_insns))
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (*fmt == 'E')
|
|
|
|
|
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
|
|
|
|
|
if (! instantiate_virtual_regs_1 (&XVECEXP (x, i, j), object,
|
|
|
|
|
extra_insns))
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Optimization: assuming this function does not receive nonlocal gotos,
|
|
|
|
|
delete the handlers for such, as well as the insns to establish
|
|
|
|
|
and disestablish them. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
delete_handlers ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Delete the handler by turning off the flag that would
|
|
|
|
|
prevent jump_optimize from deleting it.
|
|
|
|
|
Also permit deletion of the nonlocal labels themselves
|
|
|
|
|
if nothing local refers to them. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree t, last_t;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LABEL_PRESERVE_P (insn) = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Remove it from the nonlocal_label list, to avoid confusing
|
|
|
|
|
flow. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (t = nonlocal_labels, last_t = 0; t;
|
|
|
|
|
last_t = t, t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_RTL (TREE_VALUE (t)) == insn)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
if (t)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (! last_t)
|
|
|
|
|
nonlocal_labels = TREE_CHAIN (nonlocal_labels);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
TREE_CHAIN (last_t) = TREE_CHAIN (t);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int can_delete = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx t;
|
|
|
|
|
for (t = nonlocal_goto_handler_slots; t != 0; t = XEXP (t, 1))
|
|
|
|
|
if (reg_mentioned_p (t, PATTERN (insn)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
can_delete = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
if (can_delete
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| (nonlocal_goto_stack_level != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& reg_mentioned_p (nonlocal_goto_stack_level,
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
PATTERN (insn))))
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
delete_related_insns (insn);
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
|
|
|
max_parm_reg_num ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
return max_parm_reg;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return the first insn following those generated by `assign_parms'. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
get_first_nonparm_insn ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (last_parm_insn)
|
|
|
|
|
return NEXT_INSN (last_parm_insn);
|
|
|
|
|
return get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return the first NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_BEG note in the function.
|
|
|
|
|
Crash if there is none. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
get_first_block_beg ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx searcher;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn = get_first_nonparm_insn ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (searcher = insn; searcher; searcher = NEXT_INSN (searcher))
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (searcher) == NOTE
|
|
|
|
|
&& NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (searcher) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_BEG)
|
|
|
|
|
return searcher;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
abort (); /* Invalid call to this function. (See comments above.) */
|
|
|
|
|
return NULL_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return 1 if EXP is an aggregate type (or a value with aggregate type).
|
|
|
|
|
This means a type for which function calls must pass an address to the
|
|
|
|
|
function or get an address back from the function.
|
|
|
|
|
EXP may be a type node or an expression (whose type is tested). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
|
|
|
aggregate_value_p (exp)
|
|
|
|
|
tree exp;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int i, regno, nregs;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx reg;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree type = (TYPE_P (exp)) ? exp : TREE_TYPE (exp);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (RETURN_IN_MEMORY (type))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Types that are TREE_ADDRESSABLE must be constructed in memory,
|
|
|
|
|
and thus can't be returned in registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (flag_pcc_struct_return && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure we have suitable call-clobbered regs to return
|
|
|
|
|
the value in; if not, we must return it in memory. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
reg = hard_function_value (type, 0, 0);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we have something other than a REG (e.g. a PARALLEL), then assume
|
|
|
|
|
it is OK. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (reg) != REG)
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
regno = REGNO (reg);
|
|
|
|
|
nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, TYPE_MODE (type));
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
|
|
|
|
|
if (! call_used_regs[regno + i])
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Assign RTL expressions to the function's parameters.
|
|
|
|
|
This may involve copying them into registers and using
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
those registers as the RTL for them. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
assign_parms (fndecl)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree fndecl;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree parm;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx entry_parm = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx stack_parm = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode promoted_mode, passed_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode nominal_mode, promoted_nominal_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
int unsignedp;
|
|
|
|
|
/* Total space needed so far for args on the stack,
|
|
|
|
|
given as a constant and a tree-expression. */
|
|
|
|
|
struct args_size stack_args_size;
|
|
|
|
|
tree fntype = TREE_TYPE (fndecl);
|
|
|
|
|
tree fnargs = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
|
|
|
|
|
/* This is used for the arg pointer when referring to stack args. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx internal_arg_pointer;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* This is a dummy PARM_DECL that we used for the function result if
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
the function returns a structure. */
|
|
|
|
|
tree function_result_decl = 0;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int varargs_setup = 0;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx conversion_insns = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct args_size alignment_pad;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if the last arg is named `__builtin_va_alist',
|
|
|
|
|
which is used on some machines for old-fashioned non-ANSI varargs.h;
|
|
|
|
|
this should be stuck onto the stack as if it had arrived there. */
|
|
|
|
|
int hide_last_arg
|
|
|
|
|
= (current_function_varargs
|
|
|
|
|
&& fnargs
|
|
|
|
|
&& (parm = tree_last (fnargs)) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& DECL_NAME (parm)
|
|
|
|
|
&& (! strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
|
|
|
|
|
"__builtin_va_alist")));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if function takes extra anonymous args.
|
|
|
|
|
This means the last named arg must be on the stack
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
right before the anonymous ones. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int stdarg
|
|
|
|
|
= (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype)))
|
|
|
|
|
!= void_type_node));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_stdarg = stdarg;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the reg that the virtual arg pointer will be translated into is
|
|
|
|
|
not a fixed reg or is the stack pointer, make a copy of the virtual
|
|
|
|
|
arg pointer, and address parms via the copy. The frame pointer is
|
|
|
|
|
considered fixed even though it is not marked as such.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The second time through, simply use ap to avoid generating rtx. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((ARG_POINTER_REGNUM == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
|
|
|
|
|
|| ! (fixed_regs[ARG_POINTER_REGNUM]
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| ARG_POINTER_REGNUM == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
internal_arg_pointer = copy_to_reg (virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
internal_arg_pointer = virtual_incoming_args_rtx;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_internal_arg_pointer = internal_arg_pointer;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
stack_args_size.constant = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
stack_args_size.var = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If struct value address is treated as the first argument, make it so. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (aggregate_value_p (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! current_function_returns_pcc_struct
|
|
|
|
|
&& struct_value_incoming_rtx == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree type = build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fntype));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
function_result_decl = build_decl (PARM_DECL, NULL_TREE, type);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
DECL_ARG_TYPE (function_result_decl) = type;
|
|
|
|
|
TREE_CHAIN (function_result_decl) = fnargs;
|
|
|
|
|
fnargs = function_result_decl;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
max_parm_reg = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc = (rtx *) xcalloc (max_parm_reg, sizeof (rtx));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
|
|
|
|
|
INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (args_so_far, fntype, NULL_RTX);
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far, fntype, NULL_RTX, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We haven't yet found an argument that we must push and pretend the
|
|
|
|
|
caller did. */
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_pretend_args_size = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (parm = fnargs; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct args_size stack_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
struct args_size arg_size;
|
|
|
|
|
int passed_pointer = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
int did_conversion = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (parm);
|
|
|
|
|
tree nominal_type = TREE_TYPE (parm);
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int pretend_named;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int last_named = 0, named_arg;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Set LAST_NAMED if this is last named arg before last
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
anonymous args. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (stdarg || current_function_varargs)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree tem;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (tem = TREE_CHAIN (parm); tem; tem = TREE_CHAIN (tem))
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_NAME (tem))
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (tem == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
last_named = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Set NAMED_ARG if this arg should be treated as a named arg. For
|
|
|
|
|
most machines, if this is a varargs/stdarg function, then we treat
|
|
|
|
|
the last named arg as if it were anonymous too. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
named_arg = STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING ? 1 : ! last_named;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_TYPE (parm) == error_mark_node
|
|
|
|
|
/* This can happen after weird syntax errors
|
|
|
|
|
or if an enum type is defined among the parms. */
|
|
|
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (parm) != PARM_DECL
|
|
|
|
|
|| passed_type == NULL)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (parm, gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm) = DECL_RTL (parm);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
TREE_USED (parm) = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* For varargs.h function, save info about regs and stack space
|
|
|
|
|
used by the individual args, not including the va_alist arg. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (hide_last_arg && last_named)
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_args_info = args_so_far;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Find mode of arg as it is passed, and mode of arg
|
|
|
|
|
as it should be during execution of this function. */
|
|
|
|
|
passed_mode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
|
|
|
|
|
nominal_mode = TYPE_MODE (nominal_type);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the parm's mode is VOID, its value doesn't matter,
|
|
|
|
|
and avoid the usual things like emit_move_insn that could crash. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (nominal_mode == VOIDmode)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (parm, const0_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm) = DECL_RTL (parm);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the parm is to be passed as a transparent union, use the
|
|
|
|
|
type of the first field for the tests below. We have already
|
|
|
|
|
verified that the modes are the same. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_TRANSPARENT_UNION (parm)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| (TREE_CODE (passed_type) == UNION_TYPE
|
|
|
|
|
&& TYPE_TRANSPARENT_UNION (passed_type)))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
passed_type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (passed_type));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* See if this arg was passed by invisible reference. It is if
|
|
|
|
|
it is an object whose size depends on the contents of the
|
|
|
|
|
object itself or if the machine requires these objects be passed
|
|
|
|
|
that way. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (passed_type)) != INTEGER_CST
|
|
|
|
|
&& contains_placeholder_p (TYPE_SIZE (passed_type)))
|
|
|
|
|
|| TREE_ADDRESSABLE (passed_type)
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
|
|
|
|
|
|| FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (args_so_far, passed_mode,
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
passed_type, named_arg)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
passed_type = nominal_type = build_pointer_type (passed_type);
|
|
|
|
|
passed_pointer = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
passed_mode = nominal_mode = Pmode;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
promoted_mode = passed_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
|
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the mode in which the arg is actually extended to. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (passed_type);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
promoted_mode = promote_mode (passed_type, promoted_mode, &unsignedp, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Let machine desc say which reg (if any) the parm arrives in.
|
|
|
|
|
0 means it arrives on the stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
|
|
|
|
|
entry_parm = FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (args_so_far, promoted_mode,
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
passed_type, named_arg);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
entry_parm = FUNCTION_ARG (args_so_far, promoted_mode,
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
passed_type, named_arg);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (entry_parm == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
promoted_mode = passed_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is the last named parameter, do any required setup for
|
|
|
|
|
varargs or stdargs. We need to know about the case of this being an
|
|
|
|
|
addressable type, in which case we skip the registers it
|
|
|
|
|
would have arrived in.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
For stdargs, LAST_NAMED will be set for two parameters, the one that
|
|
|
|
|
is actually the last named, and the dummy parameter. We only
|
|
|
|
|
want to do this action once.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Also, indicate when RTL generation is to be suppressed. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (last_named && !varargs_setup)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (args_so_far, promoted_mode, passed_type,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_pretend_args_size, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
varargs_setup = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Determine parm's home in the stack,
|
|
|
|
|
in case it arrives in the stack or we should pretend it did.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Compute the stack position and rtx where the argument arrives
|
|
|
|
|
and its size.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There is one complexity here: If this was a parameter that would
|
|
|
|
|
have been passed in registers, but wasn't only because it is
|
|
|
|
|
__builtin_va_alist, we want locate_and_pad_parm to treat it as if
|
|
|
|
|
it came in a register so that REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE isn't skipped.
|
|
|
|
|
In this case, we call FUNCTION_ARG with NAMED set to 1 instead of
|
|
|
|
|
0 as it was the previous time. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
pretend_named = named_arg || PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
locate_and_pad_parm (promoted_mode, passed_type,
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
|
|
|
|
|
1,
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
|
|
|
|
|
FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (args_so_far, promoted_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
passed_type,
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
pretend_named) != 0,
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
FUNCTION_ARG (args_so_far, promoted_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
passed_type,
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
pretend_named) != 0,
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fndecl, &stack_args_size, &stack_offset, &arg_size,
|
|
|
|
|
&alignment_pad);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx offset_rtx = ARGS_SIZE_RTX (stack_offset);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (offset_rtx == const0_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm = gen_rtx_MEM (promoted_mode, internal_arg_pointer);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm = gen_rtx_MEM (promoted_mode,
|
|
|
|
|
gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
|
|
|
|
internal_arg_pointer,
|
|
|
|
|
offset_rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (stack_parm, parm, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this parameter was passed both in registers and in the stack,
|
|
|
|
|
use the copy on the stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (promoted_mode, passed_type))
|
|
|
|
|
entry_parm = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this parm was passed part in regs and part in memory,
|
|
|
|
|
pretend it arrived entirely in memory
|
|
|
|
|
by pushing the register-part onto the stack.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In the special case of a DImode or DFmode that is split,
|
|
|
|
|
we could put it together in a pseudoreg directly,
|
|
|
|
|
but for now that's not worth bothering with. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (entry_parm)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int nregs = FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (args_so_far, promoted_mode,
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
passed_type, named_arg);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (nregs > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_pretend_args_size
|
|
|
|
|
= (((nregs * UNITS_PER_WORD) + (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT) - 1)
|
|
|
|
|
/ (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
|
|
|
|
* (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT));
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
|
|
|
|
|
locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_group_store (validize_mem (stack_parm), entry_parm,
|
|
|
|
|
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
move_block_from_reg (REGNO (entry_parm),
|
|
|
|
|
validize_mem (stack_parm), nregs,
|
|
|
|
|
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
entry_parm = stack_parm;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we didn't decide this parm came in a register,
|
|
|
|
|
by default it came on the stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (entry_parm == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
entry_parm = stack_parm;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Record permanently how this parm was passed. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm) = entry_parm;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If there is actually space on the stack for this parm,
|
|
|
|
|
count it in stack_args_size; otherwise set stack_parm to 0
|
|
|
|
|
to indicate there is no preallocated stack slot for the parm. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (entry_parm == stack_parm
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL
|
|
|
|
|
&& XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, 0), 0) == NULL_RTX)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE) && ! defined (MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
|
|
|
|
|
/* On some machines, even if a parm value arrives in a register
|
|
|
|
|
there is still an (uninitialized) stack slot allocated for it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
??? When MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is defined, we can't tell
|
|
|
|
|
whether this parameter already has a stack slot allocated,
|
|
|
|
|
because an arg block exists only if current_function_args_size
|
|
|
|
|
is larger than some threshold, and we haven't calculated that
|
|
|
|
|
yet. So, for now, we just assume that stack slots never exist
|
|
|
|
|
in this case. */
|
|
|
|
|
|| REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl) > 0
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
stack_args_size.constant += arg_size.constant;
|
|
|
|
|
if (arg_size.var)
|
|
|
|
|
ADD_PARM_SIZE (stack_args_size, arg_size.var);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
/* No stack slot was pushed for this parm. */
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Update info on where next arg arrives in registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (args_so_far, promoted_mode,
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
passed_type, named_arg);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we can't trust the parm stack slot to be aligned enough
|
|
|
|
|
for its ultimate type, don't use that slot after entry.
|
|
|
|
|
We'll make another stack slot, if we need one. */
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unsigned int thisparm_boundary
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
= FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (promoted_mode, passed_type);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (nominal_mode) > thisparm_boundary)
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If parm was passed in memory, and we need to convert it on entry,
|
|
|
|
|
don't store it back in that same slot. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (entry_parm != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& nominal_mode != BLKmode && nominal_mode != passed_mode)
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* When an argument is passed in multiple locations, we can't
|
|
|
|
|
make use of this information, but we can save some copying if
|
|
|
|
|
the whole argument is passed in a single register. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL
|
|
|
|
|
&& nominal_mode != BLKmode && passed_mode != BLKmode)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int i, len = XVECLEN (entry_parm, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0) != NULL_RTX
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0))
|
|
|
|
|
== passed_mode)
|
|
|
|
|
&& INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 1)) == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
entry_parm = XEXP (XVECEXP (entry_parm, 0, i), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm) = entry_parm;
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* ENTRY_PARM is an RTX for the parameter as it arrives,
|
|
|
|
|
in the mode in which it arrives.
|
|
|
|
|
STACK_PARM is an RTX for a stack slot where the parameter can live
|
|
|
|
|
during the function (in case we want to put it there).
|
|
|
|
|
STACK_PARM is 0 if no stack slot was pushed for it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Now output code if necessary to convert ENTRY_PARM to
|
|
|
|
|
the type in which this function declares it,
|
|
|
|
|
and store that result in an appropriate place,
|
|
|
|
|
which may be a pseudo reg, may be STACK_PARM,
|
|
|
|
|
or may be a local stack slot if STACK_PARM is 0.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Set DECL_RTL to that place. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (nominal_mode == BLKmode || GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If a BLKmode arrives in registers, copy it to a stack slot.
|
|
|
|
|
Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
|
|
|
|
|
locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int size_stored
|
|
|
|
|
= CEIL_ROUND (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (parm)),
|
|
|
|
|
UNITS_PER_WORD);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Note that we will be storing an integral number of words.
|
|
|
|
|
So we have to be careful to ensure that we allocate an
|
|
|
|
|
integral number of words. We do this below in the
|
|
|
|
|
assign_stack_local if space was not allocated in the argument
|
|
|
|
|
list. If it was, this will not work if PARM_BOUNDARY is not
|
|
|
|
|
a multiple of BITS_PER_WORD. It isn't clear how to fix this
|
|
|
|
|
if it becomes a problem. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (stack_parm == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm
|
|
|
|
|
= assign_stack_local (GET_MODE (entry_parm),
|
|
|
|
|
size_stored, 0);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (stack_parm, parm, 1);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
else if (PARM_BOUNDARY % BITS_PER_WORD != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
|
|
|
|
|
locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (entry_parm) == PARALLEL)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_group_store (validize_mem (stack_parm), entry_parm,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
move_block_from_reg (REGNO (entry_parm),
|
|
|
|
|
validize_mem (stack_parm),
|
|
|
|
|
size_stored / UNITS_PER_WORD,
|
|
|
|
|
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (parm, stack_parm);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else if (! ((! optimize
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! DECL_REGISTER (parm))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (parm)
|
|
|
|
|
/* If -ffloat-store specified, don't put explicit
|
|
|
|
|
float variables into registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
|| (flag_float_store
|
|
|
|
|
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) == REAL_TYPE))
|
|
|
|
|
/* Always assign pseudo to structure return or item passed
|
|
|
|
|
by invisible reference. */
|
|
|
|
|
|| passed_pointer || parm == function_result_decl)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Store the parm in a pseudoregister during the function, but we
|
|
|
|
|
may need to do it in a wider mode. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx parmreg;
|
|
|
|
|
unsigned int regno, regnoi = 0, regnor = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
promoted_nominal_mode
|
|
|
|
|
= promote_mode (TREE_TYPE (parm), nominal_mode, &unsignedp, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
parmreg = gen_reg_rtx (promoted_nominal_mode);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mark_user_reg (parmreg);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this was an item that we received a pointer to, set DECL_RTL
|
|
|
|
|
appropriately. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (passed_pointer)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx x = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (passed_type)),
|
|
|
|
|
parmreg);
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (x, parm, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (parm, x);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (parm, parmreg);
|
|
|
|
|
maybe_set_unchanging (DECL_RTL (parm), parm);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Copy the value into the register. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (nominal_mode != passed_mode
|
|
|
|
|
|| promoted_nominal_mode != promoted_mode)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int save_tree_used;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* ENTRY_PARM has been converted to PROMOTED_MODE, its
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mode, by the caller. We now have to convert it to
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
NOMINAL_MODE, if different. However, PARMREG may be in
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
a different mode than NOMINAL_MODE if it is being stored
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
promoted.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If ENTRY_PARM is a hard register, it might be in a register
|
|
|
|
|
not valid for operating in its mode (e.g., an odd-numbered
|
|
|
|
|
register for a DFmode). In that case, moves are the only
|
|
|
|
|
thing valid, so we can't do a convert from there. This
|
|
|
|
|
occurs when the calling sequence allow such misaligned
|
|
|
|
|
usages.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
In addition, the conversion may involve a call, which could
|
|
|
|
|
clobber parameters which haven't been copied to pseudo
|
|
|
|
|
registers yet. Therefore, we must first copy the parm to
|
|
|
|
|
a pseudo reg here, and save the conversion until after all
|
|
|
|
|
parameters have been moved. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (entry_parm));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (tempreg, validize_mem (entry_parm));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
push_to_sequence (conversion_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
tempreg = convert_to_mode (nominal_mode, tempreg, unsignedp);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (tempreg) == SUBREG
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_MODE (tempreg) == nominal_mode
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tempreg)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& nominal_mode == passed_mode
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tempreg)) == GET_MODE (entry_parm)
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (tempreg))
|
|
|
|
|
< GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (entry_parm)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* The argument is already sign/zero extended, so note it
|
|
|
|
|
into the subreg. */
|
|
|
|
|
SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (tempreg) = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (tempreg) = unsignedp;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* TREE_USED gets set erroneously during expand_assignment. */
|
|
|
|
|
save_tree_used = TREE_USED (parm);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
expand_assignment (parm,
|
|
|
|
|
make_tree (nominal_type, tempreg), 0, 0);
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
TREE_USED (parm) = save_tree_used;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
conversion_insns = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
did_conversion = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (parmreg, validize_mem (entry_parm));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we were passed a pointer but the actual value
|
|
|
|
|
can safely live in a register, put it in one. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (passed_pointer && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) != BLKmode
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& ! ((! optimize
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! DECL_REGISTER (parm))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (parm)
|
|
|
|
|
/* If -ffloat-store specified, don't put explicit
|
|
|
|
|
float variables into registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
|| (flag_float_store
|
|
|
|
|
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) == REAL_TYPE)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* We can't use nominal_mode, because it will have been set to
|
|
|
|
|
Pmode above. We must use the actual mode of the parm. */
|
|
|
|
|
parmreg = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
mark_user_reg (parmreg);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (parmreg) != GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (parm)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (parm)));
|
|
|
|
|
int unsigned_p = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm));
|
|
|
|
|
push_to_sequence (conversion_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (tempreg, DECL_RTL (parm));
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (parm,
|
|
|
|
|
convert_to_mode (GET_MODE (parmreg),
|
|
|
|
|
tempreg,
|
|
|
|
|
unsigned_p));
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (parmreg, DECL_RTL (parm));
|
|
|
|
|
conversion_insns = get_insns();
|
|
|
|
|
did_conversion = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (parmreg, DECL_RTL (parm));
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (parm, parmreg);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* STACK_PARM is the pointer, not the parm, and PARMREG is
|
|
|
|
|
now the parm. */
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we are passed an arg by reference and it is our responsibility
|
|
|
|
|
to make a copy, do it now.
|
|
|
|
|
PASSED_TYPE and PASSED mode now refer to the pointer, not the
|
|
|
|
|
original argument, so we must recreate them in the call to
|
|
|
|
|
FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES. */
|
|
|
|
|
/* ??? Later add code to handle the case that if the argument isn't
|
|
|
|
|
modified, don't do the copy. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
else if (passed_pointer
|
|
|
|
|
&& FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (args_so_far,
|
|
|
|
|
TYPE_MODE (DECL_ARG_TYPE (parm)),
|
|
|
|
|
DECL_ARG_TYPE (parm),
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
named_arg)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& ! TREE_ADDRESSABLE (DECL_ARG_TYPE (parm)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx copy;
|
|
|
|
|
tree type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (parm);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* This sequence may involve a library call perhaps clobbering
|
|
|
|
|
registers that haven't been copied to pseudos yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
push_to_sequence (conversion_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (!COMPLETE_TYPE_P (type)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) != INTEGER_CST)
|
|
|
|
|
/* This is a variable sized object. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
copy = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode,
|
|
|
|
|
allocate_dynamic_stack_space
|
|
|
|
|
(expr_size (parm), NULL_RTX,
|
|
|
|
|
TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
copy = assign_stack_temp (TYPE_MODE (type),
|
|
|
|
|
int_size_in_bytes (type), 1);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (copy, parm, 1);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
store_expr (parm, copy, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (parmreg, XEXP (copy, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
conversion_insns = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
did_conversion = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif /* FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* In any case, record the parm's desired stack location
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
in case we later discover it must live in the stack.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If it is a COMPLEX value, store the stack location for both
|
|
|
|
|
halves. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (parmreg) == CONCAT)
|
|
|
|
|
regno = MAX (REGNO (XEXP (parmreg, 0)), REGNO (XEXP (parmreg, 1)));
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
regno = REGNO (parmreg);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (regno >= max_parm_reg)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx *new;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int old_max_parm_reg = max_parm_reg;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* It's slow to expand this one register at a time,
|
|
|
|
|
but it's also rare and we need max_parm_reg to be
|
|
|
|
|
precisely correct. */
|
|
|
|
|
max_parm_reg = regno + 1;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
new = (rtx *) xrealloc (parm_reg_stack_loc,
|
|
|
|
|
max_parm_reg * sizeof (rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
memset ((char *) (new + old_max_parm_reg), 0,
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
(max_parm_reg - old_max_parm_reg) * sizeof (rtx));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc = new;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (parmreg) == CONCAT)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode submode = GET_MODE (XEXP (parmreg, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
regnor = REGNO (gen_realpart (submode, parmreg));
|
|
|
|
|
regnoi = REGNO (gen_imagpart (submode, parmreg));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (stack_parm != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc[regnor]
|
|
|
|
|
= gen_realpart (submode, stack_parm);
|
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc[regnoi]
|
|
|
|
|
= gen_imagpart (submode, stack_parm);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc[regnor] = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc[regnoi] = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc[REGNO (parmreg)] = stack_parm;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mark the register as eliminable if we did no conversion
|
|
|
|
|
and it was copied from memory at a fixed offset,
|
|
|
|
|
and the arg pointer was not copied to a pseudo-reg.
|
|
|
|
|
If the arg pointer is a pseudo reg or the offset formed
|
|
|
|
|
an invalid address, such memory-equivalences
|
|
|
|
|
as we make here would screw up life analysis for it. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (nominal_mode == passed_mode
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! did_conversion
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& stack_parm != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (stack_parm) == MEM
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& stack_offset.var == 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& reg_mentioned_p (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
XEXP (stack_parm, 0)))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx linsn = get_last_insn ();
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx sinsn, set;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mark complex types separately. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (parmreg) == CONCAT)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Scan backwards for the set of the real and
|
|
|
|
|
imaginary parts. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (sinsn = linsn; sinsn != 0;
|
|
|
|
|
sinsn = prev_nonnote_insn (sinsn))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
set = single_set (sinsn);
|
|
|
|
|
if (set != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& SET_DEST (set) == regno_reg_rtx [regnoi])
|
|
|
|
|
REG_NOTES (sinsn)
|
|
|
|
|
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV,
|
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc[regnoi],
|
|
|
|
|
REG_NOTES (sinsn));
|
|
|
|
|
else if (set != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& SET_DEST (set) == regno_reg_rtx [regnor])
|
|
|
|
|
REG_NOTES (sinsn)
|
|
|
|
|
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV,
|
|
|
|
|
parm_reg_stack_loc[regnor],
|
|
|
|
|
REG_NOTES (sinsn));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if ((set = single_set (linsn)) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& SET_DEST (set) == parmreg)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
REG_NOTES (linsn)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUIV,
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm, REG_NOTES (linsn));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* For pointer data type, suggest pointer register. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (parm)))
|
|
|
|
|
mark_reg_pointer (parmreg,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm))));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If something wants our address, try to use ADDRESSOF. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (parm))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we end up putting something into the stack,
|
|
|
|
|
fixup_var_refs_insns will need to make a pass over
|
|
|
|
|
all the instructions. It looks through the pending
|
|
|
|
|
sequences -- but it can't see the ones in the
|
|
|
|
|
CONVERSION_INSNS, if they're not on the sequence
|
|
|
|
|
stack. So, we go back to that sequence, just so that
|
|
|
|
|
the fixups will happen. */
|
|
|
|
|
push_to_sequence (conversion_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
put_var_into_stack (parm);
|
|
|
|
|
conversion_insns = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Value must be stored in the stack slot STACK_PARM
|
|
|
|
|
during function execution. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (promoted_mode != nominal_mode)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Conversion is required. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx tempreg = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (entry_parm));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (tempreg, validize_mem (entry_parm));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
push_to_sequence (conversion_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
entry_parm = convert_to_mode (nominal_mode, tempreg,
|
|
|
|
|
TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (stack_parm)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* ??? This may need a big-endian conversion on sparc64. */
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm = adjust_address (stack_parm, nominal_mode, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
conversion_insns = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
did_conversion = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (entry_parm != stack_parm)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (stack_parm == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
stack_parm
|
|
|
|
|
= assign_stack_local (GET_MODE (entry_parm),
|
|
|
|
|
GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (entry_parm)), 0);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (stack_parm, parm, 1);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (promoted_mode != nominal_mode)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
push_to_sequence (conversion_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (validize_mem (stack_parm),
|
|
|
|
|
validize_mem (entry_parm));
|
|
|
|
|
conversion_insns = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (validize_mem (stack_parm),
|
|
|
|
|
validize_mem (entry_parm));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (parm, stack_parm);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If this "parameter" was the place where we are receiving the
|
|
|
|
|
function's incoming structure pointer, set up the result. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (parm == function_result_decl)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree result = DECL_RESULT (fndecl);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx addr = DECL_RTL (parm);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (addr) != Pmode)
|
|
|
|
|
addr = convert_memory_address (Pmode, addr);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
x = gen_rtx_MEM (DECL_MODE (result), addr);
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (x, result, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (result, x);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (parm)) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
REGNO_DECL (REGNO (DECL_RTL (parm))) = parm;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (parm)) == CONCAT)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
REGNO_DECL (REGNO (XEXP (DECL_RTL (parm), 0))) = parm;
|
|
|
|
|
REGNO_DECL (REGNO (XEXP (DECL_RTL (parm), 1))) = parm;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Output all parameter conversion instructions (possibly including calls)
|
|
|
|
|
now that all parameters have been copied out of hard registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insns (conversion_insns);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
last_parm_insn = get_last_insn ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_args_size = stack_args_size.constant;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Adjust function incoming argument size for alignment and
|
|
|
|
|
minimum length. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_args_size = MAX (current_function_args_size,
|
|
|
|
|
REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl));
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#define STACK_BYTES (STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_args_size
|
|
|
|
|
= ((current_function_args_size + STACK_BYTES - 1)
|
|
|
|
|
/ STACK_BYTES) * STACK_BYTES;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_arg_offset_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
= (stack_args_size.var == 0 ? GEN_INT (-stack_args_size.constant)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
: expand_expr (size_diffop (stack_args_size.var,
|
|
|
|
|
size_int (-stack_args_size.constant)),
|
|
|
|
|
NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_arg_offset_rtx = ARGS_SIZE_RTX (stack_args_size);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* See how many bytes, if any, of its args a function should try to pop
|
|
|
|
|
on return. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_pops_args = RETURN_POPS_ARGS (fndecl, TREE_TYPE (fndecl),
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_args_size);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* For stdarg.h function, save info about
|
|
|
|
|
regs and stack space used by the named args. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!hide_last_arg)
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_args_info = args_so_far;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Set the rtx used for the function return value. Put this in its
|
|
|
|
|
own variable so any optimizers that need this information don't have
|
|
|
|
|
to include tree.h. Do this here so it gets done when an inlined
|
|
|
|
|
function gets output. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_return_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
= (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
|
|
|
|
|
? DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (fndecl)) : NULL_RTX);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate whether REGNO is an incoming argument to the current function
|
|
|
|
|
that was promoted to a wider mode. If so, return the RTX for the
|
|
|
|
|
register (to get its mode). PMODE and PUNSIGNEDP are set to the mode
|
|
|
|
|
that REGNO is promoted from and whether the promotion was signed or
|
|
|
|
|
unsigned. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
promoted_input_arg (regno, pmode, punsignedp)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
unsigned int regno;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode *pmode;
|
|
|
|
|
int *punsignedp;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree arg;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl); arg;
|
|
|
|
|
arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& REGNO (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg)) == regno
|
|
|
|
|
&& TYPE_MODE (DECL_ARG_TYPE (arg)) == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg));
|
|
|
|
|
int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (arg));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
mode = promote_mode (TREE_TYPE (arg), mode, &unsignedp, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
if (mode == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg))
|
|
|
|
|
&& mode != DECL_MODE (arg))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
*pmode = DECL_MODE (arg);
|
|
|
|
|
*punsignedp = unsignedp;
|
|
|
|
|
return DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the size and offset from the start of the stacked arguments for a
|
|
|
|
|
parm passed in mode PASSED_MODE and with type TYPE.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
INITIAL_OFFSET_PTR points to the current offset into the stacked
|
|
|
|
|
arguments.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The starting offset and size for this parm are returned in *OFFSET_PTR
|
|
|
|
|
and *ARG_SIZE_PTR, respectively.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
IN_REGS is non-zero if the argument will be passed in registers. It will
|
|
|
|
|
never be set if REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is not defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
FNDECL is the function in which the argument was defined.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There are two types of rounding that are done. The first, controlled by
|
|
|
|
|
FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY, forces the offset from the start of the argument
|
|
|
|
|
list to be aligned to the specific boundary (in bits). This rounding
|
|
|
|
|
affects the initial and starting offsets, but not the argument size.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
The second, controlled by FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING and PARM_BOUNDARY,
|
|
|
|
|
optionally rounds the size of the parm to PARM_BOUNDARY. The
|
|
|
|
|
initial offset is not affected by this rounding, while the size always
|
|
|
|
|
is and the starting offset may be. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* offset_ptr will be negative for ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD case;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
initial_offset_ptr is positive because locate_and_pad_parm's
|
|
|
|
|
callers pass in the total size of args so far as
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
initial_offset_ptr. arg_size_ptr is always positive. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
locate_and_pad_parm (passed_mode, type, in_regs, fndecl,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
initial_offset_ptr, offset_ptr, arg_size_ptr,
|
|
|
|
|
alignment_pad)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode passed_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
tree type;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int in_regs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct args_size *initial_offset_ptr;
|
|
|
|
|
struct args_size *offset_ptr;
|
|
|
|
|
struct args_size *arg_size_ptr;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct args_size *alignment_pad;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree sizetree
|
|
|
|
|
= type ? size_in_bytes (type) : size_int (GET_MODE_SIZE (passed_mode));
|
|
|
|
|
enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (passed_mode, type);
|
|
|
|
|
int boundary = FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (passed_mode, type);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we have found a stack parm before we reach the end of the
|
|
|
|
|
area reserved for registers, skip that area. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (! in_regs)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int reg_parm_stack_space = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
|
reg_parm_stack_space = MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE;
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
reg_parm_stack_space = REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
if (reg_parm_stack_space > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
initial_offset_ptr->var
|
|
|
|
|
= size_binop (MAX_EXPR, ARGS_SIZE_TREE (*initial_offset_ptr),
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
ssize_int (reg_parm_stack_space));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
initial_offset_ptr->constant = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (initial_offset_ptr->constant < reg_parm_stack_space)
|
|
|
|
|
initial_offset_ptr->constant = reg_parm_stack_space;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif /* REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
arg_size_ptr->var = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
arg_size_ptr->constant = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
alignment_pad->var = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
alignment_pad->constant = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
|
if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->constant = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, ssize_int (0),
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
initial_offset_ptr->var);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->constant = -initial_offset_ptr->constant;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->var = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
if (where_pad != none
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& (!host_integerp (sizetree, 1)
|
|
|
|
|
|| (tree_low_cst (sizetree, 1) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
sizetree = round_up (sizetree, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
|
|
|
|
SUB_PARM_SIZE (*offset_ptr, sizetree);
|
|
|
|
|
if (where_pad != downward)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
pad_to_arg_alignment (offset_ptr, boundary, alignment_pad);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (initial_offset_ptr->var)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
arg_size_ptr->var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
|
|
|
|
|
size_binop (MINUS_EXPR,
|
|
|
|
|
ssize_int (0),
|
|
|
|
|
initial_offset_ptr->var),
|
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->var);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
arg_size_ptr->constant = (-initial_offset_ptr->constant
|
|
|
|
|
- offset_ptr->constant);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else /* !ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (!in_regs
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
|
|
|
|
|
|| REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fndecl) > 0
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
|
pad_to_arg_alignment (initial_offset_ptr, boundary, alignment_pad);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
*offset_ptr = *initial_offset_ptr;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
|
|
|
|
if (passed_mode != BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
sizetree = size_int (PUSH_ROUNDING (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (sizetree)));
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Pad_below needs the pre-rounded size to know how much to pad below
|
|
|
|
|
so this must be done before rounding up. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (where_pad == downward
|
|
|
|
|
/* However, BLKmode args passed in regs have their padding done elsewhere.
|
|
|
|
|
The stack slot must be able to hold the entire register. */
|
|
|
|
|
&& !(in_regs && passed_mode == BLKmode))
|
|
|
|
|
pad_below (offset_ptr, passed_mode, sizetree);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (where_pad != none
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& (!host_integerp (sizetree, 1)
|
|
|
|
|
|| (tree_low_cst (sizetree, 1) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
sizetree = round_up (sizetree, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ADD_PARM_SIZE (*arg_size_ptr, sizetree);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif /* ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD */
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Round the stack offset in *OFFSET_PTR up to a multiple of BOUNDARY.
|
|
|
|
|
BOUNDARY is measured in bits, but must be a multiple of a storage unit. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
pad_to_arg_alignment (offset_ptr, boundary, alignment_pad)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct args_size *offset_ptr;
|
|
|
|
|
int boundary;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
struct args_size *alignment_pad;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree save_var = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT save_constant = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int boundary_in_bytes = boundary / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
save_var = offset_ptr->var;
|
|
|
|
|
save_constant = offset_ptr->constant;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
alignment_pad->var = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
alignment_pad->constant = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (boundary > BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (offset_ptr->var)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->var =
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
round_down
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
round_up
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
(ARGS_SIZE_TREE (*offset_ptr),
|
|
|
|
|
boundary / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->constant = 0; /*?*/
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
|
|
|
|
|
alignment_pad->var = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, offset_ptr->var,
|
|
|
|
|
save_var);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->constant =
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
FLOOR_ROUND (offset_ptr->constant, boundary_in_bytes);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
CEIL_ROUND (offset_ptr->constant, boundary_in_bytes);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (boundary > PARM_BOUNDARY && boundary > STACK_BOUNDARY)
|
|
|
|
|
alignment_pad->constant = offset_ptr->constant - save_constant;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifndef ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
pad_below (offset_ptr, passed_mode, sizetree)
|
|
|
|
|
struct args_size *offset_ptr;
|
|
|
|
|
enum machine_mode passed_mode;
|
|
|
|
|
tree sizetree;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (passed_mode != BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (passed_mode) % PARM_BOUNDARY)
|
|
|
|
|
offset_ptr->constant
|
|
|
|
|
+= (((GET_MODE_BITSIZE (passed_mode) + PARM_BOUNDARY - 1)
|
|
|
|
|
/ PARM_BOUNDARY * PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
|
|
|
|
- GET_MODE_SIZE (passed_mode));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (sizetree) != INTEGER_CST
|
|
|
|
|
|| (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (sizetree) * BITS_PER_UNIT) % PARM_BOUNDARY)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Round the size up to multiple of PARM_BOUNDARY bits. */
|
|
|
|
|
tree s2 = round_up (sizetree, PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
|
|
|
|
/* Add it in. */
|
|
|
|
|
ADD_PARM_SIZE (*offset_ptr, s2);
|
|
|
|
|
SUB_PARM_SIZE (*offset_ptr, sizetree);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Walk the tree of blocks describing the binding levels within a function
|
|
|
|
|
and warn about uninitialized variables.
|
|
|
|
|
This is done after calling flow_analysis and before global_alloc
|
|
|
|
|
clobbers the pseudo-regs to hard regs. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
uninitialized_vars_warning (block)
|
|
|
|
|
tree block;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree decl, sub;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (warn_uninitialized
|
|
|
|
|
&& TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* These warnings are unreliable for and aggregates
|
|
|
|
|
because assigning the fields one by one can fail to convince
|
|
|
|
|
flow.c that the entire aggregate was initialized.
|
|
|
|
|
Unions are troublesome because members may be shorter. */
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
&& DECL_RTL (decl) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (decl)) == REG
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Global optimizations can make it difficult to determine if a
|
|
|
|
|
particular variable has been initialized. However, a VAR_DECL
|
|
|
|
|
with a nonzero DECL_INITIAL had an initializer, so do not
|
|
|
|
|
claim it is potentially uninitialized.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We do not care about the actual value in DECL_INITIAL, so we do
|
|
|
|
|
not worry that it may be a dangling pointer. */
|
|
|
|
|
&& DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& regno_uninitialized (REGNO (DECL_RTL (decl))))
|
|
|
|
|
warning_with_decl (decl,
|
|
|
|
|
"`%s' might be used uninitialized in this function");
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (extra_warnings
|
|
|
|
|
&& TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& DECL_RTL (decl) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (decl)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& regno_clobbered_at_setjmp (REGNO (DECL_RTL (decl))))
|
|
|
|
|
warning_with_decl (decl,
|
|
|
|
|
"variable `%s' might be clobbered by `longjmp' or `vfork'");
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block); sub; sub = TREE_CHAIN (sub))
|
|
|
|
|
uninitialized_vars_warning (sub);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Do the appropriate part of uninitialized_vars_warning
|
|
|
|
|
but for arguments instead of local variables. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
setjmp_args_warning ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_RTL (decl) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (decl)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& regno_clobbered_at_setjmp (REGNO (DECL_RTL (decl))))
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
warning_with_decl (decl,
|
|
|
|
|
"argument `%s' might be clobbered by `longjmp' or `vfork'");
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this function call setjmp, put all vars into the stack
|
|
|
|
|
unless they were declared `register'. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
setjmp_protect (block)
|
|
|
|
|
tree block;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree decl, sub;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
|
|
|
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
|
|
|
|
|
&& DECL_RTL (decl) != 0
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (decl)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (decl)) == MEM
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0)) == ADDRESSOF))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If this variable came from an inline function, it must be
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
that its life doesn't overlap the setjmp. If there was a
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
setjmp in the function, it would already be in memory. We
|
|
|
|
|
must exclude such variable because their DECL_RTL might be
|
|
|
|
|
set to strange things such as virtual_stack_vars_rtx. */
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! DECL_FROM_INLINE (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
&& (
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef NON_SAVING_SETJMP
|
|
|
|
|
/* If longjmp doesn't restore the registers,
|
|
|
|
|
don't put anything in them. */
|
|
|
|
|
NON_SAVING_SETJMP
|
|
|
|
|
||
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
! DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
|
|
|
|
|
put_var_into_stack (decl);
|
|
|
|
|
for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block); sub; sub = TREE_CHAIN (sub))
|
|
|
|
|
setjmp_protect (sub);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Like the previous function, but for args instead of local variables. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
setjmp_protect_args ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
|
|
|
|
|
|| TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
|
|
|
|
|
&& DECL_RTL (decl) != 0
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (decl)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (decl)) == MEM
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0)) == ADDRESSOF))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
&& (
|
|
|
|
|
/* If longjmp doesn't restore the registers,
|
|
|
|
|
don't put anything in them. */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef NON_SAVING_SETJMP
|
|
|
|
|
NON_SAVING_SETJMP
|
|
|
|
|
||
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
! DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
|
|
|
|
|
put_var_into_stack (decl);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return the context-pointer register corresponding to DECL,
|
|
|
|
|
or 0 if it does not need one. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
lookup_static_chain (decl)
|
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree context = decl_function_context (decl);
|
|
|
|
|
tree link;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (context == 0
|
|
|
|
|
|| (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && DECL_NO_STATIC_CHAIN (decl)))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* We treat inline_function_decl as an alias for the current function
|
|
|
|
|
because that is the inline function whose vars, types, etc.
|
|
|
|
|
are being merged into the current function.
|
|
|
|
|
See expand_inline_function. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (context == current_function_decl || context == inline_function_decl)
|
|
|
|
|
return virtual_stack_vars_rtx;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (link = context_display; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_PURPOSE (link) == context)
|
|
|
|
|
return RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_VALUE (link));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Convert a stack slot address ADDR for variable VAR
|
|
|
|
|
(from a containing function)
|
|
|
|
|
into an address valid in this function (using a static chain). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
fix_lexical_addr (addr, var)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx addr;
|
|
|
|
|
tree var;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx basereg;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT displacement;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree context = decl_function_context (var);
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *fp;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx base = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is the present function, we need not do anything. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (context == current_function_decl || context == inline_function_decl)
|
|
|
|
|
return addr;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fp = find_function_data (context);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == ADDRESSOF && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
addr = XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Decode given address as base reg plus displacement. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (addr) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
basereg = addr, displacement = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
|
|
|
|
basereg = XEXP (addr, 0), displacement = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1));
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We accept vars reached via the containing function's
|
|
|
|
|
incoming arg pointer and via its stack variables pointer. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (basereg == fp->internal_arg_pointer)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If reached via arg pointer, get the arg pointer value
|
|
|
|
|
out of that function's stack frame.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
There are two cases: If a separate ap is needed, allocate a
|
|
|
|
|
slot in the outer function for it and dereference it that way.
|
|
|
|
|
This is correct even if the real ap is actually a pseudo.
|
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, just adjust the offset from the frame pointer to
|
|
|
|
|
compensate. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef NEED_SEPARATE_AP
|
|
|
|
|
rtx addr;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
addr = get_arg_pointer_save_area (fp);
|
|
|
|
|
addr = fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (addr, 0), var);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
addr = memory_address (Pmode, addr);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
base = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, addr);
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_alias_set (base, get_frame_alias_set ());
|
|
|
|
|
base = copy_to_reg (base);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
displacement += (FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (context) - STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET);
|
|
|
|
|
base = lookup_static_chain (var);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
else if (basereg == virtual_stack_vars_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* This is the same code as lookup_static_chain, duplicated here to
|
|
|
|
|
avoid an extra call to decl_function_context. */
|
|
|
|
|
tree link;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (link = context_display; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_PURPOSE (link) == context)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
base = RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_VALUE (link));
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (base == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Use same offset, relative to appropriate static chain or argument
|
|
|
|
|
pointer. */
|
|
|
|
|
return plus_constant (base, displacement);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return the address of the trampoline for entering nested fn FUNCTION.
|
|
|
|
|
If necessary, allocate a trampoline (in the stack frame)
|
|
|
|
|
and emit rtl to initialize its contents (at entry to this function). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
trampoline_address (function)
|
|
|
|
|
tree function;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree link;
|
|
|
|
|
tree rtlexp;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tramp;
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *fp;
|
|
|
|
|
tree fn_context;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Find an existing trampoline and return it. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (link = trampoline_list; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_PURPOSE (link) == function)
|
|
|
|
|
return
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
adjust_trampoline_addr (XEXP (RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_VALUE (link)), 0));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (fp = outer_function_chain; fp; fp = fp->outer)
|
|
|
|
|
for (link = fp->x_trampoline_list; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_PURPOSE (link) == function)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tramp = fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_VALUE (link)), 0),
|
|
|
|
|
function);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return adjust_trampoline_addr (tramp);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* None exists; we must make one. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Find the `struct function' for the function containing FUNCTION. */
|
|
|
|
|
fp = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
fn_context = decl_function_context (function);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (fn_context != current_function_decl
|
|
|
|
|
&& fn_context != inline_function_decl)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fp = find_function_data (fn_context);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate run-time space for this trampoline
|
|
|
|
|
(usually in the defining function's stack frame). */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
|
|
|
|
|
tramp = ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (fp);
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
/* If rounding needed, allocate extra space
|
|
|
|
|
to ensure we have TRAMPOLINE_SIZE bytes left after rounding up. */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#define TRAMPOLINE_REAL_SIZE \
|
|
|
|
|
(TRAMPOLINE_SIZE + (TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) - 1)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
#define TRAMPOLINE_REAL_SIZE (TRAMPOLINE_SIZE)
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tramp = assign_stack_local_1 (BLKmode, TRAMPOLINE_REAL_SIZE, 0,
|
|
|
|
|
fp ? fp : cfun);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Record the trampoline for reuse and note it for later initialization
|
|
|
|
|
by expand_function_end. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (fp != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtlexp = make_node (RTL_EXPR);
|
|
|
|
|
RTL_EXPR_RTL (rtlexp) = tramp;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
fp->x_trampoline_list = tree_cons (function, rtlexp,
|
|
|
|
|
fp->x_trampoline_list);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make the RTL_EXPR node temporary, not momentary, so that the
|
|
|
|
|
trampoline_list doesn't become garbage. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtlexp = make_node (RTL_EXPR);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
RTL_EXPR_RTL (rtlexp) = tramp;
|
|
|
|
|
trampoline_list = tree_cons (function, rtlexp, trampoline_list);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
tramp = fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (tramp, 0), function);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return adjust_trampoline_addr (tramp);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Given a trampoline address,
|
|
|
|
|
round it to multiple of TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx
|
|
|
|
|
round_trampoline_addr (tramp)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tramp;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
|
|
|
|
|
/* Round address up to desired boundary. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx addend = GEN_INT (TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx mask = GEN_INT (-TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, tramp, addend,
|
|
|
|
|
temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
|
|
|
|
tramp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, AND, temp, mask,
|
|
|
|
|
temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
return tramp;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Given a trampoline address, round it then apply any
|
|
|
|
|
platform-specific adjustments so that the result can be used for a
|
|
|
|
|
function call . */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx
|
|
|
|
|
adjust_trampoline_addr (tramp)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tramp;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tramp = round_trampoline_addr (tramp);
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
|
|
|
|
|
TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (tramp);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
return tramp;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Put all this function's BLOCK nodes including those that are chained
|
|
|
|
|
onto the first block into a vector, and return it.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
Also store in each NOTE for the beginning or end of a block
|
|
|
|
|
the index of that block in the vector.
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
The arguments are BLOCK, the chain of top-level blocks of the function,
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
and INSNS, the insn chain of the function. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
identify_blocks ()
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int n_blocks;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree *block_vector, *last_block_vector;
|
|
|
|
|
tree *block_stack;
|
|
|
|
|
tree block = DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (block == 0)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Fill the BLOCK_VECTOR with all of the BLOCKs in this function, in
|
|
|
|
|
depth-first order. */
|
|
|
|
|
block_vector = get_block_vector (block, &n_blocks);
|
|
|
|
|
block_stack = (tree *) xmalloc (n_blocks * sizeof (tree));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
last_block_vector = identify_blocks_1 (get_insns (),
|
|
|
|
|
block_vector + 1,
|
|
|
|
|
block_vector + n_blocks,
|
|
|
|
|
block_stack);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we didn't use all of the subblocks, we've misplaced block notes. */
|
|
|
|
|
/* ??? This appears to happen all the time. Latent bugs elsewhere? */
|
|
|
|
|
if (0 && last_block_vector != block_vector + n_blocks)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
free (block_vector);
|
|
|
|
|
free (block_stack);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Subroutine of identify_blocks. Do the block substitution on the
|
|
|
|
|
insn chain beginning with INSNS. Recurse for CALL_PLACEHOLDER chains.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_STACK is pushed and popped for each BLOCK_BEGIN/BLOCK_END pair.
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_VECTOR is incremented for each block seen. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static tree *
|
|
|
|
|
identify_blocks_1 (insns, block_vector, end_block_vector, orig_block_stack)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insns;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree *block_vector;
|
|
|
|
|
tree *end_block_vector;
|
|
|
|
|
tree *orig_block_stack;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree *block_stack = orig_block_stack;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = insns; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_BEG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree b;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If there are more block notes than BLOCKs, something
|
|
|
|
|
is badly wrong. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (block_vector == end_block_vector)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
b = *block_vector++;
|
|
|
|
|
NOTE_BLOCK (insn) = b;
|
|
|
|
|
*block_stack++ = b;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_END)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If there are more NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_ENDs than
|
|
|
|
|
NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_BEGs, something is badly wrong. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (block_stack == orig_block_stack)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
NOTE_BLOCK (insn) = *--block_stack;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CALL_PLACEHOLDER)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx cp = PATTERN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
block_vector = identify_blocks_1 (XEXP (cp, 0), block_vector,
|
|
|
|
|
end_block_vector, block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (cp, 1))
|
|
|
|
|
block_vector = identify_blocks_1 (XEXP (cp, 1), block_vector,
|
|
|
|
|
end_block_vector, block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (cp, 2))
|
|
|
|
|
block_vector = identify_blocks_1 (XEXP (cp, 2), block_vector,
|
|
|
|
|
end_block_vector, block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If there are more NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_BEGINs than NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_ENDs,
|
|
|
|
|
something is badly wrong. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (block_stack != orig_block_stack)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return block_vector;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Identify BLOCKs referenced by more than one NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_{BEG,END},
|
|
|
|
|
and create duplicate blocks. */
|
|
|
|
|
/* ??? Need an option to either create block fragments or to create
|
|
|
|
|
abstract origin duplicates of a source block. It really depends
|
|
|
|
|
on what optimization has been performed. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks ()
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree block = DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
varray_type block_stack;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (block == NULL_TREE)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_TREE_INIT (block_stack, 10, "block_stack");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Reset the TREE_ASM_WRITTEN bit for all blocks. */
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks_0 (block);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Prune the old trees away, so that they don't get in the way. */
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_CHAIN (block) = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Recreate the block tree from the note nesting. */
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks_1 (get_insns (), block, &block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = blocks_nreverse (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Remove deleted blocks from the block fragment chains. */
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_fix_fragments (block);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_FREE (block_stack);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Helper function for reorder_blocks. Reset TREE_ASM_WRITTEN. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks_0 (block)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree block;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
while (block)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks_0 (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
block = BLOCK_CHAIN (block);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks_1 (insns, current_block, p_block_stack)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insns;
|
|
|
|
|
tree current_block;
|
|
|
|
|
varray_type *p_block_stack;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (insn = insns; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_BEG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree block = NOTE_BLOCK (insn);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we have seen this block before, that means it now
|
|
|
|
|
spans multiple address regions. Create a new fragment. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree new_block = copy_node (block);
|
|
|
|
|
tree origin;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
origin = (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block)
|
|
|
|
|
? BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block)
|
|
|
|
|
: block);
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (new_block) = origin;
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (new_block)
|
|
|
|
|
= BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (origin);
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (origin) = new_block;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
NOTE_BLOCK (insn) = new_block;
|
|
|
|
|
block = new_block;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block) = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block) = current_block;
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_CHAIN (block) = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block);
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block) = block;
|
|
|
|
|
current_block = block;
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (*p_block_stack, block);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_BLOCK_END)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
NOTE_BLOCK (insn) = VARRAY_TOP_TREE (*p_block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_POP (*p_block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block)
|
|
|
|
|
= blocks_nreverse (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (current_block));
|
|
|
|
|
current_block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (current_block);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CALL_PLACEHOLDER)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx cp = PATTERN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks_1 (XEXP (cp, 0), current_block, p_block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (cp, 1))
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks_1 (XEXP (cp, 1), current_block, p_block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
if (XEXP (cp, 2))
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_blocks_1 (XEXP (cp, 2), current_block, p_block_stack);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Rationalize BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN. If an origin block no longer
|
|
|
|
|
appears in the block tree, select one of the fragments to become
|
|
|
|
|
the new origin block. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_fix_fragments (block)
|
|
|
|
|
tree block;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
while (block)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree dup_origin = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (block);
|
|
|
|
|
tree new_origin = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (dup_origin)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (dup_origin))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
new_origin = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (dup_origin);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Find the first of the remaining fragments. There must
|
|
|
|
|
be at least one -- the current block. */
|
|
|
|
|
while (! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (new_origin))
|
|
|
|
|
new_origin = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (new_origin);
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (new_origin) = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (! dup_origin)
|
|
|
|
|
new_origin = block;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Re-root the rest of the fragments to the new origin. In the
|
|
|
|
|
case that DUP_ORIGIN was null, that means BLOCK was the origin
|
|
|
|
|
of a chain of fragments and we want to remove those fragments
|
|
|
|
|
that didn't make it to the output. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (new_origin)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree *pp = &BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (new_origin);
|
|
|
|
|
tree chain = *pp;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while (chain)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (chain))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (chain) = new_origin;
|
|
|
|
|
*pp = chain;
|
|
|
|
|
pp = &BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
*pp = NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_fix_fragments (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block));
|
|
|
|
|
block = BLOCK_CHAIN (block);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Reverse the order of elements in the chain T of blocks,
|
|
|
|
|
and return the new head of the chain (old last element). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static tree
|
|
|
|
|
blocks_nreverse (t)
|
|
|
|
|
tree t;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree prev = 0, decl, next;
|
|
|
|
|
for (decl = t; decl; decl = next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
next = BLOCK_CHAIN (decl);
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_CHAIN (decl) = prev;
|
|
|
|
|
prev = decl;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
return prev;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Count the subblocks of the list starting with BLOCK. If VECTOR is
|
|
|
|
|
non-NULL, list them all into VECTOR, in a depth-first preorder
|
|
|
|
|
traversal of the block tree. Also clear TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in all
|
|
|
|
|
blocks. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
|
|
|
all_blocks (block, vector)
|
|
|
|
|
tree block;
|
|
|
|
|
tree *vector;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int n_blocks = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while (block)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (block) = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Record this block. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (vector)
|
|
|
|
|
vector[n_blocks] = block;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
++n_blocks;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Record the subblocks, and their subblocks... */
|
|
|
|
|
n_blocks += all_blocks (BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block),
|
|
|
|
|
vector ? vector + n_blocks : 0);
|
|
|
|
|
block = BLOCK_CHAIN (block);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return n_blocks;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Return a vector containing all the blocks rooted at BLOCK. The
|
|
|
|
|
number of elements in the vector is stored in N_BLOCKS_P. The
|
|
|
|
|
vector is dynamically allocated; it is the caller's responsibility
|
|
|
|
|
to call `free' on the pointer returned. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static tree *
|
|
|
|
|
get_block_vector (block, n_blocks_p)
|
|
|
|
|
tree block;
|
|
|
|
|
int *n_blocks_p;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree *block_vector;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*n_blocks_p = all_blocks (block, NULL);
|
|
|
|
|
block_vector = (tree *) xmalloc (*n_blocks_p * sizeof (tree));
|
|
|
|
|
all_blocks (block, block_vector);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return block_vector;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int next_block_index = 2;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Set BLOCK_NUMBER for all the blocks in FN. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
number_blocks (fn)
|
|
|
|
|
tree fn;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
|
int n_blocks;
|
|
|
|
|
tree *block_vector;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* For SDB and XCOFF debugging output, we start numbering the blocks
|
|
|
|
|
from 1 within each function, rather than keeping a running
|
|
|
|
|
count. */
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined (SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
|
|
|
|
|
if (write_symbols == SDB_DEBUG || write_symbols == XCOFF_DEBUG)
|
|
|
|
|
next_block_index = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
block_vector = get_block_vector (DECL_INITIAL (fn), &n_blocks);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* The top-level BLOCK isn't numbered at all. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 1; i < n_blocks; ++i)
|
|
|
|
|
/* We number the blocks from two. */
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_NUMBER (block_vector[i]) = next_block_index++;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
free (block_vector);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If VAR is present in a subblock of BLOCK, return the subblock. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
tree
|
|
|
|
|
debug_find_var_in_block_tree (var, block)
|
|
|
|
|
tree var;
|
|
|
|
|
tree block;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree t;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (t = BLOCK_VARS (block); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
|
|
|
|
|
if (t == var)
|
|
|
|
|
return block;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (t = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (block); t; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree ret = debug_find_var_in_block_tree (var, t);
|
|
|
|
|
if (ret)
|
|
|
|
|
return ret;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return NULL_TREE;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Allocate a function structure and reset its contents to the defaults. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
prepare_function_start ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
cfun = (struct function *) ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct function));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
init_stmt_for_function ();
|
|
|
|
|
init_eh_for_function ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
cse_not_expected = ! optimize;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Caller save not needed yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
caller_save_needed = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* No stack slots have been made yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
stack_slot_list = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_has_nonlocal_label = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_has_nonlocal_goto = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* There is no stack slot for handling nonlocal gotos. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
nonlocal_goto_handler_slots = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
nonlocal_goto_stack_level = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* No labels have been declared for nonlocal use. */
|
|
|
|
|
nonlocal_labels = 0;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
nonlocal_goto_handler_labels = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* No function calls so far in this function. */
|
|
|
|
|
function_call_count = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* No parm regs have been allocated.
|
|
|
|
|
(This is important for output_inline_function.) */
|
|
|
|
|
max_parm_reg = LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize the RTL mechanism. */
|
|
|
|
|
init_emit ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize the queue of pending postincrement and postdecrements,
|
|
|
|
|
and some other info in expr.c. */
|
|
|
|
|
init_expr ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We haven't done register allocation yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
reg_renumber = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
init_varasm_status (cfun);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Clear out data used for inlining. */
|
|
|
|
|
cfun->inlinable = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
cfun->original_decl_initial = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
cfun->original_arg_vector = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
cfun->stack_alignment_needed = STACK_BOUNDARY;
|
|
|
|
|
cfun->preferred_stack_boundary = STACK_BOUNDARY;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Set if a call to setjmp is seen. */
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_calls_setjmp = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Set if a call to longjmp is seen. */
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_calls_longjmp = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_calls_alloca = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_contains_functions = 0;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_is_leaf = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_nothrow = 0;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_sp_is_unchanging = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_has_computed_jump = 0;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_is_thunk = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_returns_pcc_struct = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_returns_struct = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_epilogue_delay_list = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_uses_const_pool = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_uses_pic_offset_table = 0;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_cannot_inline = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We have not yet needed to make a label to jump to for tail-recursion. */
|
|
|
|
|
tail_recursion_label = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We haven't had a need to make a save area for ap yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
arg_pointer_save_area = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* No stack slots allocated yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
frame_offset = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* No SAVE_EXPRs in this function yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
save_expr_regs = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* No RTL_EXPRs in this function yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtl_expr_chain = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Set up to allocate temporaries. */
|
|
|
|
|
init_temp_slots ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate that we need to distinguish between the return value of the
|
|
|
|
|
present function and the return value of a function being called. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx_equal_function_value_matters = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate that we have not instantiated virtual registers yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
virtuals_instantiated = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate that we want CONCATs now. */
|
|
|
|
|
generating_concat_p = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate we have no need of a frame pointer yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
frame_pointer_needed = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* By default assume not varargs or stdarg. */
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_varargs = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_stdarg = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* We haven't made any trampolines for this function yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
trampoline_list = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
init_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
|
|
|
|
inhibit_defer_pop = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_outgoing_args_size = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (init_lang_status)
|
|
|
|
|
(*init_lang_status) (cfun);
|
|
|
|
|
if (init_machine_status)
|
|
|
|
|
(*init_machine_status) (cfun);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize the rtl expansion mechanism so that we can do simple things
|
|
|
|
|
like generate sequences. This is used to provide a context during global
|
|
|
|
|
initialization of some passes. */
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
init_dummy_function_start ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
prepare_function_start ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Generate RTL for the start of the function SUBR (a FUNCTION_DECL tree node)
|
|
|
|
|
and initialize static variables for generating RTL for the statements
|
|
|
|
|
of the function. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
init_function_start (subr, filename, line)
|
|
|
|
|
tree subr;
|
|
|
|
|
const char *filename;
|
|
|
|
|
int line;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
prepare_function_start ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_name = (*decl_printable_name) (subr, 2);
|
|
|
|
|
cfun->decl = subr;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Nonzero if this is a nested function that uses a static chain. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_needs_context
|
|
|
|
|
= (decl_function_context (current_function_decl) != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! DECL_NO_STATIC_CHAIN (current_function_decl));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Within function body, compute a type's size as soon it is laid out. */
|
|
|
|
|
immediate_size_expand++;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Prevent ever trying to delete the first instruction of a function.
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
Also tell final how to output a linenum before the function prologue.
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
Note linenums could be missing, e.g. when compiling a Java .class file. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (line > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_line_note (filename, line);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure first insn is a note even if we don't want linenums.
|
|
|
|
|
This makes sure the first insn will never be deleted.
|
|
|
|
|
Also, final expects a note to appear there. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Set flags used by final.c. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (aggregate_value_p (DECL_RESULT (subr)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_returns_pcc_struct = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_returns_struct = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Warn if this value is an aggregate type,
|
|
|
|
|
regardless of which calling convention we are using for it. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (warn_aggregate_return
|
|
|
|
|
&& AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr))))
|
|
|
|
|
warning ("function returns an aggregate");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_returns_pointer
|
|
|
|
|
= POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr)));
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure all values used by the optimization passes have sane
|
|
|
|
|
defaults. */
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
init_function_for_compilation ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
reg_renumber = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* No prologue/epilogue insns yet. */
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_GROW (prologue, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_GROW (epilogue, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_GROW (sibcall_epilogue, 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate that the current function uses extra args
|
|
|
|
|
not explicitly mentioned in the argument list in any fashion. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
mark_varargs ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_varargs = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Expand a call to __main at the beginning of a possible main function. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP) && !defined(INVOKE__main)
|
|
|
|
|
#undef HAS_INIT_SECTION
|
|
|
|
|
#define HAS_INIT_SECTION
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
First round of changes to support generation of assembler for the old
a.out gas and the binutils gas (elf or a.out) with a single compiler.
This uses other infrastructure not yet committed, in order to support
both a.out and elf it needs to be able to get to both a.out and elf
gas, ld, libs, crt* etc. So for now, the support is pretty much dormant.
The new freebsd.h file is based on the old freebsd-elf.h file (which has a
long lineage, right back through linux and svr4 files). The change is
pretty dramatic from a gcc internals standpoint as it overrides a lot of
definitions in order to generate different output based on target mode.
There is potential for screw-ups, so please be on the lookout - gcc's
configuration mechanism wasn't really meant for this kind of thing.
It's believed to compile world etc just fine under both a.out and elf, can
handle global constructors and destructors, handles the differences in
a.out and elf stabs, and what sections things like exceptions go in.
The initial idea came from i386/osfrose.h which is a dual rose/elf format
target. These two are not as diverse as a.out and elf it would seem.
The cc front-end uses external configuration to determine default object
format (still being thrashed out, so read the source if you want to see
it so far), and has a '-aout' and '-elf' override command line switch.
There are some other internal switches that can be accessed, namely -maout,
-mno-aout, -munderscores and -mnounderscores. The underscore and local
symbol prefixing rules are controllable seperately to the output format.
(ie: it's possible to generate a.out without the _ prefixes on symbols and
also to generate elf with the _ prefixes. This isn't quite optimal, but
does seem to work pretty well, except the linkers don't always recognise
the local symbols without their normal names)
The default format is a.out (still), nobody should see any major changes.
With both elf and a.out tools and libraries installed:
[1:26pm]/tmp-223> cc -elf -o hello hello.c
peter@beast[1:27pm]/tmp-224> file hello
hello: ELF 32-bit LSB executable, Intel 80386, version 1 (FreeBSD), dynamically linked, not stripped
[1:27pm]/tmp-225> ./hello
hello world!
[1:27pm]/tmp-226> cc -aout -o hello hello.c
[1:27pm]/tmp-227> file hello
hello: FreeBSD/i386 compact demand paged dynamically linked executable not stripped
1:27pm]/tmp-228> ./hello
hello world!
Since my co-conspirators put a lot of effort into this too, I'll add them
so they can share the blame^H^H^H^H^Hglory. :-)
Reviewed by: sos, jdp
1998-03-08 05:29:49 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifndef GEN_CALL__MAIN
|
|
|
|
|
#define GEN_CALL__MAIN \
|
|
|
|
|
do { \
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_library_call (gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, NAME__MAIN), LCT_NORMAL, \
|
First round of changes to support generation of assembler for the old
a.out gas and the binutils gas (elf or a.out) with a single compiler.
This uses other infrastructure not yet committed, in order to support
both a.out and elf it needs to be able to get to both a.out and elf
gas, ld, libs, crt* etc. So for now, the support is pretty much dormant.
The new freebsd.h file is based on the old freebsd-elf.h file (which has a
long lineage, right back through linux and svr4 files). The change is
pretty dramatic from a gcc internals standpoint as it overrides a lot of
definitions in order to generate different output based on target mode.
There is potential for screw-ups, so please be on the lookout - gcc's
configuration mechanism wasn't really meant for this kind of thing.
It's believed to compile world etc just fine under both a.out and elf, can
handle global constructors and destructors, handles the differences in
a.out and elf stabs, and what sections things like exceptions go in.
The initial idea came from i386/osfrose.h which is a dual rose/elf format
target. These two are not as diverse as a.out and elf it would seem.
The cc front-end uses external configuration to determine default object
format (still being thrashed out, so read the source if you want to see
it so far), and has a '-aout' and '-elf' override command line switch.
There are some other internal switches that can be accessed, namely -maout,
-mno-aout, -munderscores and -mnounderscores. The underscore and local
symbol prefixing rules are controllable seperately to the output format.
(ie: it's possible to generate a.out without the _ prefixes on symbols and
also to generate elf with the _ prefixes. This isn't quite optimal, but
does seem to work pretty well, except the linkers don't always recognise
the local symbols without their normal names)
The default format is a.out (still), nobody should see any major changes.
With both elf and a.out tools and libraries installed:
[1:26pm]/tmp-223> cc -elf -o hello hello.c
peter@beast[1:27pm]/tmp-224> file hello
hello: ELF 32-bit LSB executable, Intel 80386, version 1 (FreeBSD), dynamically linked, not stripped
[1:27pm]/tmp-225> ./hello
hello world!
[1:27pm]/tmp-226> cc -aout -o hello hello.c
[1:27pm]/tmp-227> file hello
hello: FreeBSD/i386 compact demand paged dynamically linked executable not stripped
1:27pm]/tmp-228> ./hello
hello world!
Since my co-conspirators put a lot of effort into this too, I'll add them
so they can share the blame^H^H^H^H^Hglory. :-)
Reviewed by: sos, jdp
1998-03-08 05:29:49 +00:00
|
|
|
|
VOIDmode, 0); \
|
|
|
|
|
} while (0)
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
expand_main_function ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
|
|
|
|
|
if (FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int align = PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tmp, seq;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
/* Forcibly align the stack. */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
|
|
|
|
tmp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, AND, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT(-align),
|
|
|
|
|
stack_pointer_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
tmp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
GEN_INT (align - 1), NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
|
|
|
|
|
tmp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, AND, tmp, GEN_INT (-align),
|
|
|
|
|
stack_pointer_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
if (tmp != stack_pointer_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, tmp);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Enlist allocate_dynamic_stack_space to pick up the pieces. */
|
|
|
|
|
tmp = force_reg (Pmode, const0_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
allocate_dynamic_stack_space (tmp, NULL_RTX, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (tmp = get_last_insn (); tmp; tmp = PREV_INSN (tmp))
|
|
|
|
|
if (NOTE_P (tmp) && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (tmp) == NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
if (tmp)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_before (seq, tmp);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn (seq);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#if defined(INVOKE__main) || !defined (HAS_INIT_SECTION)
|
|
|
|
|
GEN_CALL__MAIN;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
extern struct obstack permanent_obstack;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* The PENDING_SIZES represent the sizes of variable-sized types.
|
|
|
|
|
Create RTL for the various sizes now (using temporary variables),
|
|
|
|
|
so that we can refer to the sizes from the RTL we are generating
|
|
|
|
|
for the current function. The PENDING_SIZES are a TREE_LIST. The
|
|
|
|
|
TREE_VALUE of each node is a SAVE_EXPR. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
expand_pending_sizes (pending_sizes)
|
|
|
|
|
tree pending_sizes;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree tem;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Evaluate now the sizes of any types declared among the arguments. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (tem = pending_sizes; tem; tem = TREE_CHAIN (tem))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
expand_expr (TREE_VALUE (tem), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
/* Flush the queue in case this parameter declaration has
|
|
|
|
|
side-effects. */
|
|
|
|
|
emit_queue ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Start the RTL for a new function, and set variables used for
|
|
|
|
|
emitting RTL.
|
|
|
|
|
SUBR is the FUNCTION_DECL node.
|
|
|
|
|
PARMS_HAVE_CLEANUPS is nonzero if there are cleanups associated with
|
|
|
|
|
the function's parameters, which must be run at any return statement. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
expand_function_start (subr, parms_have_cleanups)
|
|
|
|
|
tree subr;
|
|
|
|
|
int parms_have_cleanups;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree tem;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx last_ptr = NULL_RTX;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure volatile mem refs aren't considered
|
|
|
|
|
valid operands of arithmetic insns. */
|
|
|
|
|
init_recog_no_volatile ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_instrument_entry_exit
|
|
|
|
|
= (flag_instrument_function_entry_exit
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! DECL_NO_INSTRUMENT_FUNCTION_ENTRY_EXIT (subr));
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
current_function_profile
|
|
|
|
|
= (profile_flag
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! DECL_NO_INSTRUMENT_FUNCTION_ENTRY_EXIT (subr));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_limit_stack
|
|
|
|
|
= (stack_limit_rtx != NULL_RTX && ! DECL_NO_LIMIT_STACK (subr));
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If function gets a static chain arg, store it in the stack frame.
|
|
|
|
|
Do this first, so it gets the first stack slot offset. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (current_function_needs_context)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
last_ptr = assign_stack_local (Pmode, GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Delay copying static chain if it is not a register to avoid
|
|
|
|
|
conflicts with regs used for parameters. */
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (! SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
|
|
|
|
|
|| GET_CODE (static_chain_incoming_rtx) == REG)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (last_ptr, static_chain_incoming_rtx);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the parameters of this function need cleaning up, get a label
|
|
|
|
|
for the beginning of the code which executes those cleanups. This must
|
|
|
|
|
be done before doing anything with return_label. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (parms_have_cleanups)
|
|
|
|
|
cleanup_label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
cleanup_label = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Make the label for return statements to jump to. Do not special
|
|
|
|
|
case machines with special return instructions -- they will be
|
|
|
|
|
handled later during jump, ifcvt, or epilogue creation. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return_label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize rtx used to return the value. */
|
|
|
|
|
/* Do this before assign_parms so that we copy the struct value address
|
|
|
|
|
before any library calls that assign parms might generate. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Decide whether to return the value in memory or in a register. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (aggregate_value_p (DECL_RESULT (subr)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Returning something that won't go in a register. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx value_address = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
|
|
|
|
|
if (current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr)));
|
|
|
|
|
value_address = assemble_static_space (size);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Expect to be passed the address of a place to store the value.
|
|
|
|
|
If it is passed as an argument, assign_parms will take care of
|
|
|
|
|
it. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (struct_value_incoming_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
value_address = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (value_address, struct_value_incoming_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
if (value_address)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx x = gen_rtx_MEM (DECL_MODE (DECL_RESULT (subr)), value_address);
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_attributes (x, DECL_RESULT (subr), 1);
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), x);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (DECL_MODE (DECL_RESULT (subr)) == VOIDmode)
|
|
|
|
|
/* If return mode is void, this decl rtl should not be used. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), NULL_RTX);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Compute the return values into a pseudo reg, which we will copy
|
|
|
|
|
into the true return register after the cleanups are done. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* In order to figure out what mode to use for the pseudo, we
|
|
|
|
|
figure out what the mode of the eventual return register will
|
|
|
|
|
actually be, and use that. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx hard_reg
|
|
|
|
|
= hard_function_value (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (subr)),
|
|
|
|
|
subr, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Structures that are returned in registers are not aggregate_value_p,
|
|
|
|
|
so we may see a PARALLEL. Don't play pseudo games with this. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (! REG_P (hard_reg))
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), hard_reg);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Create the pseudo. */
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (subr), gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (hard_reg)));
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Needed because we may need to move this to memory
|
|
|
|
|
in case it's a named return value whose address is taken. */
|
|
|
|
|
DECL_REGISTER (DECL_RESULT (subr)) = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize rtx for parameters and local variables.
|
|
|
|
|
In some cases this requires emitting insns. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
assign_parms (subr);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Copy the static chain now if it wasn't a register. The delay is to
|
|
|
|
|
avoid conflicts with the parameter passing registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES && current_function_needs_context)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (static_chain_incoming_rtx) != REG)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (last_ptr, static_chain_incoming_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* The following was moved from init_function_start.
|
|
|
|
|
The move is supposed to make sdb output more accurate. */
|
|
|
|
|
/* Indicate the beginning of the function body,
|
|
|
|
|
as opposed to parm setup. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (get_last_insn ()) != NOTE)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
parm_birth_insn = get_last_insn ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
context_display = 0;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (current_function_needs_context)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Fetch static chain values for containing functions. */
|
|
|
|
|
tem = decl_function_context (current_function_decl);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Copy the static chain pointer into a pseudo. If we have
|
|
|
|
|
small register classes, copy the value from memory if
|
|
|
|
|
static_chain_incoming_rtx is a REG. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (tem)
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the static chain originally came in a register, put it back
|
|
|
|
|
there, then move it out in the next insn. The reason for
|
|
|
|
|
this peculiar code is to satisfy function integration. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (static_chain_incoming_rtx) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (static_chain_incoming_rtx, last_ptr);
|
|
|
|
|
last_ptr = copy_to_reg (static_chain_incoming_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
while (tem)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree rtlexp = make_node (RTL_EXPR);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
RTL_EXPR_RTL (rtlexp) = last_ptr;
|
|
|
|
|
context_display = tree_cons (tem, rtlexp, context_display);
|
|
|
|
|
tem = decl_function_context (tem);
|
|
|
|
|
if (tem == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
/* Chain thru stack frames, assuming pointer to next lexical frame
|
|
|
|
|
is found at the place we always store it. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
last_ptr = plus_constant (last_ptr,
|
|
|
|
|
-(HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
last_ptr = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, memory_address (Pmode, last_ptr));
|
|
|
|
|
set_mem_alias_set (last_ptr, get_frame_alias_set ());
|
|
|
|
|
last_ptr = copy_to_reg (last_ptr);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we are not optimizing, ensure that we know that this
|
|
|
|
|
piece of context is live over the entire function. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (! optimize)
|
|
|
|
|
save_expr_regs = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, last_ptr,
|
|
|
|
|
save_expr_regs);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (current_function_instrument_entry_exit)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx fun = DECL_RTL (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (fun) == MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
fun = XEXP (fun, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_library_call (profile_function_entry_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode,
|
|
|
|
|
2, fun, Pmode,
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
expand_builtin_return_addr (BUILT_IN_RETURN_ADDRESS,
|
|
|
|
|
0,
|
|
|
|
|
hard_frame_pointer_rtx),
|
|
|
|
|
Pmode);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef PROFILE_HOOK
|
|
|
|
|
if (current_function_profile)
|
|
|
|
|
PROFILE_HOOK (profile_label_no);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* After the display initializations is where the tail-recursion label
|
|
|
|
|
should go, if we end up needing one. Ensure we have a NOTE here
|
|
|
|
|
since some things (like trampolines) get placed before this. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tail_recursion_reentry = emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_DELETED);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Evaluate now the sizes of any types declared among the arguments. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
expand_pending_sizes (nreverse (get_pending_sizes ()));
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Make sure there is a line number after the function entry setup code. */
|
|
|
|
|
force_next_line_note ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Undo the effects of init_dummy_function_start. */
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
expand_dummy_function_end ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* End any sequences that failed to be closed due to syntax errors. */
|
|
|
|
|
while (in_sequence_p ())
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Outside function body, can't compute type's actual size
|
|
|
|
|
until next function's body starts. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
free_after_parsing (cfun);
|
|
|
|
|
free_after_compilation (cfun);
|
|
|
|
|
cfun = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Call DOIT for each hard register used as a return value from
|
|
|
|
|
the current function. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
diddle_return_value (doit, arg)
|
|
|
|
|
void (*doit) PARAMS ((rtx, void *));
|
|
|
|
|
void *arg;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx outgoing = current_function_return_rtx;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (! outgoing)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (outgoing) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
(*doit) (outgoing, arg);
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (outgoing) == PARALLEL)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (outgoing, 0); i++)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx x = XEXP (XVECEXP (outgoing, 0, i), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
|
|
|
|
(*doit) (x, arg);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
do_clobber_return_reg (reg, arg)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx reg;
|
|
|
|
|
void *arg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, reg));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
clobber_return_register ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
diddle_return_value (do_clobber_return_reg, NULL);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* In case we do use pseudo to return value, clobber it too. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree decl_result = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (decl_result);
|
|
|
|
|
if (REG_P (decl_rtl) && REGNO (decl_rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
do_clobber_return_reg (decl_rtl, NULL);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
do_use_return_reg (reg, arg)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx reg;
|
|
|
|
|
void *arg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
use_return_register ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
diddle_return_value (do_use_return_reg, NULL);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Generate RTL for the end of the current function.
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
FILENAME and LINE are the current position in the source file.
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
It is up to language-specific callers to do cleanups for parameters--
|
|
|
|
|
or else, supply 1 for END_BINDINGS and we will call expand_end_bindings. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
expand_function_end (filename, line, end_bindings)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
const char *filename;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int line;
|
|
|
|
|
int end_bindings;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree link;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx clobber_after;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
static rtx initial_trampoline;
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
finish_expr_for_function ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If arg_pointer_save_area was referenced only from a nested
|
|
|
|
|
function, we will not have initialized it yet. Do that now. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (arg_pointer_save_area && ! cfun->arg_pointer_save_area_init)
|
|
|
|
|
get_arg_pointer_save_area (cfun);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef NON_SAVING_SETJMP
|
|
|
|
|
/* Don't put any variables in registers if we call setjmp
|
|
|
|
|
on a machine that fails to restore the registers. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (NON_SAVING_SETJMP && current_function_calls_setjmp)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl) != error_mark_node)
|
|
|
|
|
setjmp_protect (DECL_INITIAL (current_function_decl));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
setjmp_protect_args ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Initialize any trampolines required by this function. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (link = trampoline_list; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree function = TREE_PURPOSE (link);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx context ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED = lookup_static_chain (function);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx tramp = RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_VALUE (link));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
|
|
|
|
|
rtx blktramp;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx seq;
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* First make sure this compilation has a template for
|
|
|
|
|
initializing trampolines. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (initial_trampoline == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
initial_trampoline
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
= gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, assemble_trampoline_template ());
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
set_mem_align (initial_trampoline, TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_add_rtx_root (&initial_trampoline, 1);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Generate insns to initialize the trampoline. */
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tramp = round_trampoline_addr (XEXP (tramp, 0));
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
blktramp = replace_equiv_address (initial_trampoline, tramp);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_block_move (blktramp, initial_trampoline,
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
GEN_INT (TRAMPOLINE_SIZE));
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (tramp, XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0), context);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
seq = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Put those insns at entry to the containing function (this one). */
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insns_before (seq, tail_recursion_reentry);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we are doing stack checking and this function makes calls,
|
|
|
|
|
do a stack probe at the start of the function to ensure we have enough
|
|
|
|
|
space for another stack frame. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (flag_stack_check && ! STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn, seq;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
probe_stack_range (STACK_CHECK_PROTECT,
|
|
|
|
|
GEN_INT (STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE));
|
|
|
|
|
seq = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insns_before (seq, tail_recursion_reentry);
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Warn about unused parms if extra warnings were specified. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Either ``-W -Wunused'' or ``-Wunused-parameter'' enables this
|
|
|
|
|
warning. WARN_UNUSED_PARAMETER is negative when set by
|
|
|
|
|
-Wunused. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (warn_unused_parameter > 0
|
|
|
|
|
|| (warn_unused_parameter < 0 && extra_warnings))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
tree decl;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (decl = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
if (! TREE_USED (decl) && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
|
|
|
|
|
&& DECL_NAME (decl) && ! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
|
|
|
|
|
warning_with_decl (decl, "unused parameter `%s'");
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Delete handlers for nonlocal gotos if nothing uses them. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (nonlocal_goto_handler_slots != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& ! current_function_has_nonlocal_label)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
delete_handlers ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* End any sequences that failed to be closed due to syntax errors. */
|
|
|
|
|
while (in_sequence_p ())
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Outside function body, can't compute type's actual size
|
|
|
|
|
until next function's body starts. */
|
|
|
|
|
immediate_size_expand--;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
clear_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
|
|
|
|
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mark the end of the function body.
|
|
|
|
|
If control reaches this insn, the function can drop through
|
|
|
|
|
without returning a value. */
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_END);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Must mark the last line number note in the function, so that the test
|
|
|
|
|
coverage code can avoid counting the last line twice. This just tells
|
|
|
|
|
the code to ignore the immediately following line note, since there
|
|
|
|
|
already exists a copy of this note somewhere above. This line number
|
|
|
|
|
note is still needed for debugging though, so we can't delete it. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (flag_test_coverage)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_REPEATED_LINE_NUMBER);
|
1999-10-15 20:48:35 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Output a linenumber for the end of the function.
|
|
|
|
|
SDB depends on this. */
|
|
|
|
|
emit_line_note_force (filename, line);
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Before the return label (if any), clobber the return
|
|
|
|
|
registers so that they are not propagated live to the rest of
|
|
|
|
|
the function. This can only happen with functions that drop
|
|
|
|
|
through; if there had been a return statement, there would
|
|
|
|
|
have either been a return rtx, or a jump to the return label.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We delay actual code generation after the current_function_value_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
is computed. */
|
|
|
|
|
clobber_after = get_last_insn ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Output the label for the actual return from the function,
|
|
|
|
|
if one is expected. This happens either because a function epilogue
|
|
|
|
|
is used instead of a return instruction, or because a return was done
|
|
|
|
|
with a goto in order to run local cleanups, or because of pcc-style
|
|
|
|
|
structure returning. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (return_label)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_label (return_label);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* C++ uses this. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (end_bindings)
|
|
|
|
|
expand_end_bindings (0, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (current_function_instrument_entry_exit)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx fun = DECL_RTL (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (fun) == MEM)
|
|
|
|
|
fun = XEXP (fun, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_library_call (profile_function_exit_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode,
|
|
|
|
|
2, fun, Pmode,
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
expand_builtin_return_addr (BUILT_IN_RETURN_ADDRESS,
|
|
|
|
|
0,
|
|
|
|
|
hard_frame_pointer_rtx),
|
|
|
|
|
Pmode);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Let except.c know where it should emit the call to unregister
|
|
|
|
|
the function context for sjlj exceptions. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (flag_exceptions && USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
|
|
|
|
|
sjlj_emit_function_exit_after (get_last_insn ());
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we had calls to alloca, and this machine needs
|
|
|
|
|
an accurate stack pointer to exit the function,
|
|
|
|
|
insert some code to save and restore the stack pointer. */
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
|
|
|
|
|
if (! EXIT_IGNORE_STACK)
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
if (current_function_calls_alloca)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx tem = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_stack_save (SAVE_FUNCTION, &tem, parm_birth_insn);
|
|
|
|
|
emit_stack_restore (SAVE_FUNCTION, tem, NULL_RTX);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If scalar return value was computed in a pseudo-reg, or was a named
|
|
|
|
|
return value that got dumped to the stack, copy that to the hard
|
|
|
|
|
return register. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree decl_result = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (decl_result);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
|
|
|
|
|
? REGNO (decl_rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
|
|
|
|
: DECL_REGISTER (decl_result))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx real_decl_rtl;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
real_decl_rtl = FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (decl_result),
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_decl);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#else
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
real_decl_rtl = FUNCTION_VALUE (TREE_TYPE (decl_result),
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (real_decl_rtl) = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a BLKmode structure being returned in registers,
|
|
|
|
|
then use the mode computed in expand_return. Note that if
|
|
|
|
|
decl_rtl is memory, then its mode may have been changed,
|
|
|
|
|
but that current_function_return_rtx has not. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (real_decl_rtl) == BLKmode)
|
|
|
|
|
PUT_MODE (real_decl_rtl, GET_MODE (current_function_return_rtx));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If a named return value dumped decl_return to memory, then
|
|
|
|
|
we may need to re-do the PROMOTE_MODE signed/unsigned
|
|
|
|
|
extension. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (real_decl_rtl) != GET_MODE (decl_rtl))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl_result));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
|
|
|
|
|
promote_mode (TREE_TYPE (decl_result), GET_MODE (decl_rtl),
|
|
|
|
|
&unsignedp, 1);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
convert_move (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl, unsignedp);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (real_decl_rtl) == PARALLEL)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_group_load (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl,
|
|
|
|
|
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl_result)));
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (real_decl_rtl, decl_rtl);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* The delay slot scheduler assumes that current_function_return_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
holds the hard register containing the return value, not a
|
|
|
|
|
temporary pseudo. */
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_return_rtx = real_decl_rtl;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If returning a structure, arrange to return the address of the value
|
|
|
|
|
in a place where debuggers expect to find it.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If returning a structure PCC style,
|
|
|
|
|
the caller also depends on this value.
|
|
|
|
|
And current_function_returns_pcc_struct is not necessarily set. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (current_function_returns_struct
|
|
|
|
|
|| current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx value_address
|
|
|
|
|
= XEXP (DECL_RTL (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)), 0);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
tree type = TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
|
|
|
|
|
rtx outgoing
|
|
|
|
|
= FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (build_pointer_type (type),
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_decl);
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
|
rtx outgoing
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
= FUNCTION_VALUE (build_pointer_type (type), current_function_decl);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mark this as a function return value so integrate will delete the
|
|
|
|
|
assignment and USE below when inlining this function. */
|
|
|
|
|
REG_FUNCTION_VALUE_P (outgoing) = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
|
|
|
|
/* The address may be ptr_mode and OUTGOING may be Pmode. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_MODE (outgoing) != GET_MODE (value_address))
|
|
|
|
|
value_address = convert_memory_address (GET_MODE (outgoing),
|
|
|
|
|
value_address);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (outgoing, value_address);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Show return register used to hold result (in this case the address
|
|
|
|
|
of the result. */
|
|
|
|
|
current_function_return_rtx = outgoing;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If this is an implementation of throw, do what's necessary to
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
communicate between __builtin_eh_return and the epilogue. */
|
|
|
|
|
expand_eh_return ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Emit the actual code to clobber return register. */
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq, after;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
clobber_return_register ();
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
after = emit_insn_after (seq, clobber_after);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (clobber_after != after)
|
|
|
|
|
cfun->x_clobber_return_insn = after;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* ??? This should no longer be necessary since stupid is no longer with
|
|
|
|
|
us, but there are some parts of the compiler (eg reload_combine, and
|
|
|
|
|
sh mach_dep_reorg) that still try and compute their own lifetime info
|
|
|
|
|
instead of using the general framework. */
|
|
|
|
|
use_return_register ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Fix up any gotos that jumped out to the outermost
|
|
|
|
|
binding level of the function.
|
|
|
|
|
Must follow emitting RETURN_LABEL. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If you have any cleanups to do at this point,
|
|
|
|
|
and they need to create temporary variables,
|
|
|
|
|
then you will lose. */
|
|
|
|
|
expand_fixups (get_insns ());
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx
|
|
|
|
|
get_arg_pointer_save_area (f)
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *f;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx ret = f->x_arg_pointer_save_area;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (! ret)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
ret = assign_stack_local_1 (Pmode, GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode), 0, f);
|
|
|
|
|
f->x_arg_pointer_save_area = ret;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (f == cfun && ! f->arg_pointer_save_area_init)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Save the arg pointer at the beginning of the function. The
|
|
|
|
|
generated stack slot may not be a valid memory address, so we
|
|
|
|
|
have to check it and fix it if necessary. */
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (validize_mem (ret), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
push_topmost_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn_after (seq, get_insns ());
|
|
|
|
|
pop_topmost_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return ret;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Extend a vector that records the INSN_UIDs of INSNS (either a
|
|
|
|
|
sequence or a single insn). */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
record_insns (insns, vecp)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insns;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
varray_type *vecp;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insns) == SEQUENCE)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int len = XVECLEN (insns, 0);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int i = VARRAY_SIZE (*vecp);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_GROW (*vecp, i + len);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
while (--len >= 0)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_INT (*vecp, i) = INSN_UID (XVECEXP (insns, 0, len));
|
|
|
|
|
++i;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int i = VARRAY_SIZE (*vecp);
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_GROW (*vecp, i + 1);
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_INT (*vecp, i) = INSN_UID (insns);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Determine how many INSN_UIDs in VEC are part of INSN. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int
|
|
|
|
|
contains (insn, vec)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
varray_type vec;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int i, j;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int count = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (j = VARRAY_SIZE (vec) - 1; j >= 0; --j)
|
|
|
|
|
if (INSN_UID (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == VARRAY_INT (vec, j))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
count++;
|
|
|
|
|
return count;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (j = VARRAY_SIZE (vec) - 1; j >= 0; --j)
|
|
|
|
|
if (INSN_UID (insn) == VARRAY_INT (vec, j))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
|
|
|
prologue_epilogue_contains (insn)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (contains (insn, prologue))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
if (contains (insn, epilogue))
|
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int
|
|
|
|
|
sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (sibcall_epilogue)
|
|
|
|
|
return contains (insn, sibcall_epilogue);
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_return
|
|
|
|
|
/* Insert gen_return at the end of block BB. This also means updating
|
|
|
|
|
block_for_insn appropriately. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
emit_return_into_block (bb, line_note)
|
|
|
|
|
basic_block bb;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx line_note;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx p, end;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p = NEXT_INSN (bb->end);
|
|
|
|
|
end = emit_jump_insn_after (gen_return (), bb->end);
|
|
|
|
|
if (line_note)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_line_note_after (NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (line_note),
|
|
|
|
|
NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (line_note), PREV_INSN (bb->end));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif /* HAVE_return */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(HAVE_epilogue) && defined(INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* These functions convert the epilogue into a variant that does not modify the
|
|
|
|
|
stack pointer. This is used in cases where a function returns an object
|
|
|
|
|
whose size is not known until it is computed. The called function leaves the
|
|
|
|
|
object on the stack, leaves the stack depressed, and returns a pointer to
|
|
|
|
|
the object.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
What we need to do is track all modifications and references to the stack
|
|
|
|
|
pointer, deleting the modifications and changing the references to point to
|
|
|
|
|
the location the stack pointer would have pointed to had the modifications
|
|
|
|
|
taken place.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
These functions need to be portable so we need to make as few assumptions
|
|
|
|
|
about the epilogue as we can. However, the epilogue basically contains
|
|
|
|
|
three things: instructions to reset the stack pointer, instructions to
|
|
|
|
|
reload registers, possibly including the frame pointer, and an
|
|
|
|
|
instruction to return to the caller.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
If we can't be sure of what a relevant epilogue insn is doing, we abort.
|
|
|
|
|
We also make no attempt to validate the insns we make since if they are
|
|
|
|
|
invalid, we probably can't do anything valid. The intent is that these
|
|
|
|
|
routines get "smarter" as more and more machines start to use them and
|
|
|
|
|
they try operating on different epilogues.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
We use the following structure to track what the part of the epilogue that
|
|
|
|
|
we've already processed has done. We keep two copies of the SP equivalence,
|
|
|
|
|
one for use during the insn we are processing and one for use in the next
|
|
|
|
|
insn. The difference is because one part of a PARALLEL may adjust SP
|
|
|
|
|
and the other may use it. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
struct epi_info
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx sp_equiv_reg; /* REG that SP is set from, perhaps SP. */
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT sp_offset; /* Offset from SP_EQUIV_REG of present SP. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx new_sp_equiv_reg; /* REG to be used at end of insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT new_sp_offset; /* Offset to be used at end of insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
rtx equiv_reg_src; /* If nonzero, the value that SP_EQUIV_REG
|
|
|
|
|
should be set to once we no longer need
|
|
|
|
|
its value. */
|
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void handle_epilogue_set PARAMS ((rtx, struct epi_info *));
|
|
|
|
|
static void emit_equiv_load PARAMS ((struct epi_info *));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Modify SEQ, a SEQUENCE that is part of the epilogue, to no modifications
|
|
|
|
|
to the stack pointer. Return the new sequence. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static rtx
|
|
|
|
|
keep_stack_depressed (seq)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
int i, j;
|
|
|
|
|
struct epi_info info;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the epilogue is just a single instruction, it ust be OK as is. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (seq) != SEQUENCE)
|
|
|
|
|
return seq;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise, start a sequence, initialize the information we have, and
|
|
|
|
|
process all the insns we were given. */
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
info.sp_equiv_reg = stack_pointer_rtx;
|
|
|
|
|
info.sp_offset = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
info.equiv_reg_src = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (seq, 0); i++)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn = XVECEXP (seq, 0, i);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!INSN_P (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
add_insn (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this insn references the register that SP is equivalent to and
|
|
|
|
|
we have a pending load to that register, we must force out the load
|
|
|
|
|
first and then indicate we no longer know what SP's equivalent is. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (info.equiv_reg_src != 0
|
|
|
|
|
&& reg_referenced_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, PATTERN (insn)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
emit_equiv_load (&info);
|
|
|
|
|
info.sp_equiv_reg = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
info.new_sp_equiv_reg = info.sp_equiv_reg;
|
|
|
|
|
info.new_sp_offset = info.sp_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this is a (RETURN) and the return address is on the stack,
|
|
|
|
|
update the address and change to an indirect jump. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == RETURN
|
|
|
|
|
|| (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == RETURN))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx retaddr = INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx base = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx jump_insn, jump_set;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the return address is in a register, we can emit the insn
|
|
|
|
|
unchanged. Otherwise, it must be a MEM and we see what the
|
|
|
|
|
base register and offset are. In any case, we have to emit any
|
|
|
|
|
pending load to the equivalent reg of SP, if any. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (retaddr) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
emit_equiv_load (&info);
|
|
|
|
|
add_insn (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (retaddr) == MEM
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (retaddr, 0)) == REG)
|
|
|
|
|
base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REGNO (XEXP (retaddr, 0))), offset = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (retaddr) == MEM
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (retaddr, 0)) == PLUS
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (retaddr, 0), 0)) == REG
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (retaddr, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (retaddr, 0), 0)));
|
|
|
|
|
offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (retaddr, 0), 1));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If the base of the location containing the return pointer
|
|
|
|
|
is SP, we must update it with the replacement address. Otherwise,
|
|
|
|
|
just build the necessary MEM. */
|
|
|
|
|
retaddr = plus_constant (base, offset);
|
|
|
|
|
if (base == stack_pointer_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
retaddr = simplify_replace_rtx (retaddr, stack_pointer_rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
plus_constant (info.sp_equiv_reg,
|
|
|
|
|
info.sp_offset));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
retaddr = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, retaddr);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If there is a pending load to the equivalent register for SP
|
|
|
|
|
and we reference that register, we must load our address into
|
|
|
|
|
a scratch register and then do that load. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (info.equiv_reg_src
|
|
|
|
|
&& reg_overlap_mentioned_p (info.equiv_reg_src, retaddr))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
unsigned int regno;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx reg;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
|
|
|
|
|
if (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, Pmode)
|
|
|
|
|
&& !fixed_regs[regno]
|
|
|
|
|
&& TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_invalidated_by_call, regno)
|
|
|
|
|
&& !REGNO_REG_SET_P (EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->global_live_at_start,
|
|
|
|
|
regno)
|
|
|
|
|
&& !refers_to_regno_p (regno,
|
|
|
|
|
regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno,
|
|
|
|
|
Pmode),
|
|
|
|
|
info.equiv_reg_src, NULL))
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (regno == FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
reg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, regno);
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (reg, retaddr);
|
|
|
|
|
retaddr = reg;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
emit_equiv_load (&info);
|
|
|
|
|
jump_insn = emit_jump_insn (gen_indirect_jump (retaddr));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Show the SET in the above insn is a RETURN. */
|
|
|
|
|
jump_set = single_set (jump_insn);
|
|
|
|
|
if (jump_set == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
SET_IS_RETURN_P (jump_set) = 1;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If SP is not mentioned in the pattern and its equivalent register, if
|
|
|
|
|
any, is not modified, just emit it. Otherwise, if neither is set,
|
|
|
|
|
replace the reference to SP and emit the insn. If none of those are
|
|
|
|
|
true, handle each SET individually. */
|
|
|
|
|
else if (!reg_mentioned_p (stack_pointer_rtx, PATTERN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
&& (info.sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
|| !reg_set_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, insn)))
|
|
|
|
|
add_insn (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
else if (! reg_set_p (stack_pointer_rtx, insn)
|
|
|
|
|
&& (info.sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx
|
|
|
|
|
|| !reg_set_p (info.sp_equiv_reg, insn)))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_replace_rtx (stack_pointer_rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
plus_constant (info.sp_equiv_reg,
|
|
|
|
|
info.sp_offset),
|
|
|
|
|
insn))
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
add_insn (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
|
|
|
|
|
handle_epilogue_set (PATTERN (insn), &info);
|
|
|
|
|
else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0); j++)
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, j)) == SET)
|
|
|
|
|
handle_epilogue_set (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, j), &info);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
add_insn (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
info.sp_equiv_reg = info.new_sp_equiv_reg;
|
|
|
|
|
info.sp_offset = info.new_sp_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
return seq;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* SET is a SET from an insn in the epilogue. P is a pointer to the epi_info
|
|
|
|
|
structure that contains information about what we've seen so far. We
|
|
|
|
|
process this SET by either updating that data or by emitting one or
|
|
|
|
|
more insns. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
handle_epilogue_set (set, p)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx set;
|
|
|
|
|
struct epi_info *p;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* First handle the case where we are setting SP. Record what it is being
|
|
|
|
|
set from. If unknown, abort. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (reg_set_p (stack_pointer_rtx, set))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (SET_DEST (set) != stack_pointer_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
|
|
|
|
|
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)) == CONST_INT)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
p->new_sp_equiv_reg = XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0);
|
|
|
|
|
p->new_sp_offset = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
p->new_sp_equiv_reg = SET_SRC (set), p->new_sp_offset = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we are adjusting SP, we adjust from the old data. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->new_sp_equiv_reg == stack_pointer_rtx)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
p->new_sp_equiv_reg = p->sp_equiv_reg;
|
|
|
|
|
p->new_sp_offset += p->sp_offset;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->new_sp_equiv_reg == 0 || GET_CODE (p->new_sp_equiv_reg) != REG)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Next handle the case where we are setting SP's equivalent register.
|
|
|
|
|
If we already have a value to set it to, abort. We could update, but
|
|
|
|
|
there seems little point in handling that case. Note that we have
|
|
|
|
|
to allow for the case where we are setting the register set in
|
|
|
|
|
the previous part of a PARALLEL inside a single insn. But use the
|
|
|
|
|
old offset for any updates within this insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
else if (p->new_sp_equiv_reg != 0 && reg_set_p (p->new_sp_equiv_reg, set))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (!rtx_equal_p (p->new_sp_equiv_reg, SET_DEST (set))
|
|
|
|
|
|| p->equiv_reg_src != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
p->equiv_reg_src
|
|
|
|
|
= simplify_replace_rtx (SET_SRC (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
|
|
|
|
|
p->sp_offset));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Otherwise, replace any references to SP in the insn to its new value
|
|
|
|
|
and emit the insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
SET_SRC (set) = simplify_replace_rtx (SET_SRC (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
|
|
|
|
|
p->sp_offset));
|
|
|
|
|
SET_DEST (set) = simplify_replace_rtx (SET_DEST (set), stack_pointer_rtx,
|
|
|
|
|
plus_constant (p->sp_equiv_reg,
|
|
|
|
|
p->sp_offset));
|
|
|
|
|
emit_insn (set);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Emit an insn to do the load shown in p->equiv_reg_src, if needed. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
emit_equiv_load (p)
|
|
|
|
|
struct epi_info *p;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->equiv_reg_src != 0)
|
|
|
|
|
emit_move_insn (p->sp_equiv_reg, p->equiv_reg_src);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
p->equiv_reg_src = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Generate the prologue and epilogue RTL if the machine supports it. Thread
|
|
|
|
|
this into place with notes indicating where the prologue ends and where
|
|
|
|
|
the epilogue begins. Update the basic block information when possible. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
thread_prologue_and_epilogue_insns (f)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx f ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int inserted = 0;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
edge e;
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined (HAVE_sibcall_epilogue) || defined (HAVE_epilogue) || defined (HAVE_return) || defined (HAVE_prologue)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx seq;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
|
|
|
|
|
rtx prologue_end = NULL_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#if defined (HAVE_epilogue) || defined(HAVE_return)
|
|
|
|
|
rtx epilogue_end = NULL_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
|
|
|
|
|
if (HAVE_prologue)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_prologue ();
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_insn (seq);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Retain a map of the prologue insns. */
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (seq) != SEQUENCE)
|
|
|
|
|
seq = get_insns ();
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
record_insns (seq, &prologue);
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
prologue_end = emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END);
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Can't deal with multiple successors of the entry block
|
|
|
|
|
at the moment. Function should always have at least one
|
|
|
|
|
entry point. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (!ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->succ || ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->succ->succ_next)
|
|
|
|
|
abort ();
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
insert_insn_on_edge (seq, ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->succ);
|
|
|
|
|
inserted = 1;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If the exit block has no non-fake predecessors, we don't need
|
|
|
|
|
an epilogue. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (e = EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->pred; e; e = e->pred_next)
|
|
|
|
|
if ((e->flags & EDGE_FAKE) == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
if (e == NULL)
|
|
|
|
|
goto epilogue_done;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_return
|
|
|
|
|
if (optimize && HAVE_return)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we're allowed to generate a simple return instruction,
|
|
|
|
|
then by definition we don't need a full epilogue. Examine
|
|
|
|
|
the block that falls through to EXIT. If it does not
|
|
|
|
|
contain any code, examine its predecessors and try to
|
|
|
|
|
emit (conditional) return instructions. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
basic_block last;
|
|
|
|
|
edge e_next;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx label;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (e = EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->pred; e; e = e->pred_next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
if (e == NULL)
|
|
|
|
|
goto epilogue_done;
|
|
|
|
|
last = e->src;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Verify that there are no active instructions in the last block. */
|
|
|
|
|
label = last->end;
|
|
|
|
|
while (label && GET_CODE (label) != CODE_LABEL)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (active_insn_p (label))
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
break;
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
label = PREV_INSN (label);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (last->head == label && GET_CODE (label) == CODE_LABEL)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx epilogue_line_note = NULL_RTX;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Locate the line number associated with the closing brace,
|
|
|
|
|
if we can find one. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (seq = get_last_insn ();
|
|
|
|
|
seq && ! active_insn_p (seq);
|
|
|
|
|
seq = PREV_INSN (seq))
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (seq) == NOTE && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (seq) > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
epilogue_line_note = seq;
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (e = last->pred; e; e = e_next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
basic_block bb = e->src;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx jump;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
e_next = e->pred_next;
|
|
|
|
|
if (bb == ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR)
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
jump = bb->end;
|
|
|
|
|
if ((GET_CODE (jump) != JUMP_INSN) || JUMP_LABEL (jump) != label)
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we have an unconditional jump, we can replace that
|
|
|
|
|
with a simple return instruction. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (simplejump_p (jump))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
emit_return_into_block (bb, epilogue_line_note);
|
|
|
|
|
delete_insn (jump);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* If we have a conditional jump, we can try to replace
|
|
|
|
|
that with a conditional return instruction. */
|
|
|
|
|
else if (condjump_p (jump))
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx ret, *loc;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
ret = SET_SRC (PATTERN (jump));
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (XEXP (ret, 1)) == LABEL_REF)
|
|
|
|
|
loc = &XEXP (ret, 1);
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
loc = &XEXP (ret, 2);
|
|
|
|
|
ret = gen_rtx_RETURN (VOIDmode);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (! validate_change (jump, loc, ret, 0))
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
if (JUMP_LABEL (jump))
|
|
|
|
|
LABEL_NUSES (JUMP_LABEL (jump))--;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this block has only one successor, it both jumps
|
|
|
|
|
and falls through to the fallthru block, so we can't
|
|
|
|
|
delete the edge. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (bb->succ->succ_next == NULL)
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Fix up the CFG for the successful change we just made. */
|
|
|
|
|
redirect_edge_succ (e, EXIT_BLOCK_PTR);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Emit a return insn for the exit fallthru block. Whether
|
|
|
|
|
this is still reachable will be determined later. */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_barrier_after (last->end);
|
|
|
|
|
emit_return_into_block (last, epilogue_line_note);
|
|
|
|
|
epilogue_end = last->end;
|
|
|
|
|
last->succ->flags &= ~EDGE_FALLTHRU;
|
|
|
|
|
goto epilogue_done;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_epilogue
|
|
|
|
|
if (HAVE_epilogue)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Find the edge that falls through to EXIT. Other edges may exist
|
|
|
|
|
due to RETURN instructions, but those don't need epilogues.
|
|
|
|
|
There really shouldn't be a mixture -- either all should have
|
|
|
|
|
been converted or none, however... */
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (e = EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->pred; e; e = e->pred_next)
|
|
|
|
|
if (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
if (e == NULL)
|
|
|
|
|
goto epilogue_done;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
epilogue_end = emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_epilogue ();
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
|
|
|
|
|
/* If this function returns with the stack depressed and we can support
|
|
|
|
|
it, massage the epilogue to actually do that. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)) == FUNCTION_TYPE
|
|
|
|
|
&& TYPE_RETURNS_STACK_DEPRESSED (TREE_TYPE (current_function_decl)))
|
|
|
|
|
seq = keep_stack_depressed (seq);
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
emit_jump_insn (seq);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Retain a map of the epilogue insns. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (seq) != SEQUENCE)
|
|
|
|
|
seq = get_insns ();
|
|
|
|
|
record_insns (seq, &epilogue);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
insert_insn_on_edge (seq, e);
|
|
|
|
|
inserted = 1;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
epilogue_done:
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (inserted)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
commit_edge_insertions ();
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_sibcall_epilogue
|
|
|
|
|
/* Emit sibling epilogues before any sibling call sites. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (e = EXIT_BLOCK_PTR->pred; e; e = e->pred_next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
basic_block bb = e->src;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn = bb->end;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx i;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx newinsn;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) != CALL_INSN
|
|
|
|
|
|| ! SIBLING_CALL_P (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
start_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
seq = gen_sibcall_epilogue ();
|
|
|
|
|
end_sequence ();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
i = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
newinsn = emit_insn_before (seq, insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Retain a map of the epilogue insns. Used in life analysis to
|
|
|
|
|
avoid getting rid of sibcall epilogue insns. */
|
|
|
|
|
record_insns (GET_CODE (seq) == SEQUENCE
|
|
|
|
|
? seq : newinsn, &sibcall_epilogue);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_prologue
|
|
|
|
|
if (prologue_end)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn, prev;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* GDB handles `break f' by setting a breakpoint on the first
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
line note after the prologue. Which means (1) that if
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
there are line number notes before where we inserted the
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
prologue we should move them, and (2) we should generate a
|
|
|
|
|
note before the end of the first basic block, if there isn't
|
|
|
|
|
one already there.
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
??? This behaviour is completely broken when dealing with
|
|
|
|
|
multiple entry functions. We simply place the note always
|
|
|
|
|
into first basic block and let alternate entry points
|
|
|
|
|
to be missed.
|
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = prologue_end; insn; insn = prev)
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
prev = PREV_INSN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
/* Note that we cannot reorder the first insn in the
|
|
|
|
|
chain, since rest_of_compilation relies on that
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
remaining constant. */
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (prev == NULL)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_insns (insn, insn, prologue_end);
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Find the last line number note in the first block. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = BASIC_BLOCK (0)->end;
|
|
|
|
|
insn != prologue_end && insn;
|
|
|
|
|
insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* If we didn't find one, make a copy of the first line number
|
|
|
|
|
we run across. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (! insn)
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (insn = next_active_insn (prologue_end);
|
|
|
|
|
insn;
|
|
|
|
|
insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
emit_line_note_after (NOTE_SOURCE_FILE (insn),
|
|
|
|
|
NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn),
|
|
|
|
|
prologue_end);
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2000-05-27 02:43:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_epilogue
|
|
|
|
|
if (epilogue_end)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn, next;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Similarly, move any line notes that appear after the epilogue.
|
|
|
|
|
There is no need, however, to be quite so anal about the existence
|
|
|
|
|
of such a note. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = epilogue_end; insn; insn = next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
reorder_insns (insn, insn, PREV_INSN (epilogue_end));
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Reposition the prologue-end and epilogue-begin notes after instruction
|
|
|
|
|
scheduling and delayed branch scheduling. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
reposition_prologue_and_epilogue_notes (f)
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx f ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined (HAVE_prologue) || defined (HAVE_epilogue)
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
int len;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ((len = VARRAY_SIZE (prologue)) > 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx insn, note = 0;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Scan from the beginning until we reach the last prologue insn.
|
|
|
|
|
We apparently can't depend on basic_block_{head,end} after
|
|
|
|
|
reorg has run. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = f; len && insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END)
|
|
|
|
|
note = insn;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if ((len -= contains (insn, prologue)) == 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
rtx next;
|
|
|
|
|
/* Find the prologue-end note if we haven't already, and
|
|
|
|
|
move it to just after the last prologue insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (note == 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (note = insn; (note = NEXT_INSN (note));)
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (note) == NOTE
|
|
|
|
|
&& NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (note) == NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
next = NEXT_INSN (note);
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Whether or not we can depend on BLOCK_HEAD,
|
|
|
|
|
attempt to keep it up-to-date. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (BLOCK_HEAD (0) == note)
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_HEAD (0) = next;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
remove_insn (note);
|
|
|
|
|
/* Avoid placing note between CODE_LABEL and BASIC_BLOCK note. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL)
|
|
|
|
|
insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
|
|
|
|
|
add_insn_after (note, insn);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if ((len = VARRAY_SIZE (epilogue)) > 0)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
rtx insn, note = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Scan from the end until we reach the first epilogue insn.
|
|
|
|
|
We apparently can't depend on basic_block_{head,end} after
|
|
|
|
|
reorg has run. */
|
|
|
|
|
for (insn = get_last_insn (); len && insn; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
if (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG)
|
|
|
|
|
note = insn;
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
else if ((len -= contains (insn, epilogue)) == 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Find the epilogue-begin note if we haven't already, and
|
|
|
|
|
move it to just before the first epilogue insn. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (note == 0)
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
{
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
for (note = insn; (note = PREV_INSN (note));)
|
|
|
|
|
if (GET_CODE (note) == NOTE
|
|
|
|
|
&& NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (note) == NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG)
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
/* Whether or not we can depend on BLOCK_HEAD,
|
|
|
|
|
attempt to keep it up-to-date. */
|
|
|
|
|
if (n_basic_blocks
|
|
|
|
|
&& BLOCK_HEAD (n_basic_blocks-1) == insn)
|
|
|
|
|
BLOCK_HEAD (n_basic_blocks-1) = note;
|
1999-10-26 08:53:03 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
remove_insn (note);
|
|
|
|
|
add_insn_before (note, insn);
|
1996-09-18 05:35:50 +00:00
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
#endif /* HAVE_prologue or HAVE_epilogue */
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
2002-02-01 19:42:45 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mark P for GC. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
mark_function_status (p)
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *p;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct var_refs_queue *q;
|
|
|
|
|
struct temp_slot *t;
|
|
|
|
|
int i;
|
|
|
|
|
rtx *r;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (p == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->arg_offset_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (p->x_parm_reg_stack_loc)
|
|
|
|
|
for (i = p->x_max_parm_reg, r = p->x_parm_reg_stack_loc;
|
|
|
|
|
i > 0; --i, ++r)
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (*r);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->return_rtx);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_cleanup_label);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_return_label);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_save_expr_regs);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_stack_slot_list);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_parm_birth_insn);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_tail_recursion_label);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_tail_recursion_reentry);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->internal_arg_pointer);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_arg_pointer_save_area);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_tree (p->x_rtl_expr_chain);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_last_parm_insn);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_tree (p->x_context_display);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_tree (p->x_trampoline_list);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->epilogue_delay_list);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_clobber_return_insn);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (t = p->x_temp_slots; t != 0; t = t->next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark (t);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (t->slot);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (t->address);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_tree (t->rtl_expr);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_tree (t->type);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (q = p->fixup_var_refs_queue; q != 0; q = q->next)
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark (q);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (q->modified);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_nonlocal_goto_handler_slots);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_nonlocal_goto_handler_labels);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtx (p->x_nonlocal_goto_stack_level);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_tree (p->x_nonlocal_labels);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
mark_hard_reg_initial_vals (p);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mark the struct function pointed to by *ARG for GC, if it is not
|
|
|
|
|
NULL. This is used to mark the current function and the outer
|
|
|
|
|
function chain. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static void
|
|
|
|
|
maybe_mark_struct_function (arg)
|
|
|
|
|
void *arg;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *f = *(struct function **) arg;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (f == 0)
|
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_struct_function (f);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Mark a struct function * for GC. This is called from ggc-common.c. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_struct_function (f)
|
|
|
|
|
struct function *f;
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark (f);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_tree (f->decl);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
mark_function_status (f);
|
|
|
|
|
mark_eh_status (f->eh);
|
|
|
|
|
mark_stmt_status (f->stmt);
|
|
|
|
|
mark_expr_status (f->expr);
|
|
|
|
|
mark_emit_status (f->emit);
|
|
|
|
|
mark_varasm_status (f->varasm);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (mark_machine_status)
|
|
|
|
|
(*mark_machine_status) (f);
|
|
|
|
|
if (mark_lang_status)
|
|
|
|
|
(*mark_lang_status) (f);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (f->original_arg_vector)
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_rtvec ((rtvec) f->original_arg_vector);
|
|
|
|
|
if (f->original_decl_initial)
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_tree (f->original_decl_initial);
|
|
|
|
|
if (f->outer)
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_mark_struct_function (f->outer);
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* Called once, at initialization, to initialize function.c. */
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void
|
|
|
|
|
init_function_once ()
|
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_add_root (&cfun, 1, sizeof cfun, maybe_mark_struct_function);
|
|
|
|
|
ggc_add_root (&outer_function_chain, 1, sizeof outer_function_chain,
|
|
|
|
|
maybe_mark_struct_function);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_INT_INIT (prologue, 0, "prologue");
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_INT_INIT (epilogue, 0, "epilogue");
|
|
|
|
|
VARRAY_INT_INIT (sibcall_epilogue, 0, "sibcall_epilogue");
|
|
|
|
|
}
|